1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- -*- coding: iso-latin-1 -*-
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
10 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
15 @setchapternewpage odd
19 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
20 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
21 \usepackage{pagestyle}
29 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
30 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
32 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
34 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
35 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
37 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
38 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
40 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}}
41 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
42 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}''}
43 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
44 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
45 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
46 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
47 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
48 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
49 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
50 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
51 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
52 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
53 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
54 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
56 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
57 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
58 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
59 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
60 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
61 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
62 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
63 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
64 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
66 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
67 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
70 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head.eps,height=1cm}}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
72 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
77 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
84 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
86 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
88 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
89 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
92 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
93 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
94 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
101 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
108 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
109 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1cm}}}
112 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
113 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
116 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
117 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
120 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
121 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
124 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
126 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
127 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
131 \newenvironment{codelist}%
136 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
142 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
147 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
152 \newenvironment{samplist}%
157 \newenvironment{varlist}%
162 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
167 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
168 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
169 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
171 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
176 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
180 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
189 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
191 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
196 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
201 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
205 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
213 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
215 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
225 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
229 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
237 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
239 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
244 \pagenumbering{roman}
245 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
255 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
256 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
258 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
260 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\\
263 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=15cm}
266 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
273 \thispagestyle{empty}
275 Copyright \copyright{} 1995,96,97,98,99,2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
278 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
279 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
280 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
281 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
282 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
283 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
284 License'' in the Emacs manual.
286 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
287 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
288 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
290 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
291 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
292 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
293 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
301 This file documents Gnus, the GNU Emacs newsreader.
303 Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,98,99,2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
305 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
306 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
307 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
308 Invariant Sections being none, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
309 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
310 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
311 License'' in the Emacs manual.
313 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
314 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
315 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
317 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
318 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
319 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
320 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
328 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
331 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
332 Copyright @copyright{} 1995,96,97,98,99,2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
334 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
335 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
336 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
337 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
338 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
339 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
340 License'' in the Emacs manual.
342 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
343 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
344 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
346 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
347 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
348 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
349 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
358 @top The Gnus Newsreader
362 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
363 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@sc{nntp}, local
364 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
367 This manual corresponds to Gnus 5.8.7.
378 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
379 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
381 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
382 being accused of plagiarism:
384 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
385 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
386 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
387 can even read news with it!
389 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
390 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
391 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
392 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
393 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
399 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
400 * The Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
401 * The Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
402 * The Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
403 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
404 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
405 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
406 * Various:: General purpose settings.
407 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
408 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, FAQ, History, Internals.
409 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
410 * Key Index:: Key Index.
413 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
417 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
418 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
419 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
420 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
421 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
422 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
423 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
424 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
425 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
431 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
432 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
433 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
437 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
438 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
439 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
440 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
441 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
442 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
443 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
444 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
445 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
446 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
447 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
448 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
449 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
450 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
451 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
452 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
453 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
457 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
458 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
459 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
463 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
464 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
465 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
466 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
467 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
471 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
472 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
473 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
474 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
478 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
479 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
480 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
481 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
482 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
483 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
484 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
485 * Threading:: How threads are made.
486 * Sorting:: How articles and threads are sorted.
487 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
488 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
489 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
490 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
491 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
492 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
493 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
494 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
495 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
496 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
497 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
498 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
499 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
500 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
501 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
502 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
503 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer.
504 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
505 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
507 Summary Buffer Format
509 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
510 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
511 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
512 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
516 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
517 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
519 Reply, Followup and Post
521 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
522 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
523 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
524 * Canceling and Superseding:: ``Whoops, I shouldn't have called him that.''
528 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
529 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
530 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
531 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
532 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
533 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
537 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
538 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
540 Customizing Threading
542 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
543 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
544 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
545 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
549 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
550 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
551 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
552 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
553 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
554 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
558 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
559 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
560 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
564 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
565 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
566 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
567 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
568 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
569 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
570 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
571 * Article Miscellania:: Various other stuff.
573 Alternative Approaches
575 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
576 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
578 Various Summary Stuff
580 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
581 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
582 * Summary Generation Commands:: (Re)generating the summary buffer.
583 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
587 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
588 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
589 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
590 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
591 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
595 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
596 * Post:: Posting and following up.
597 * Posting Server:: What server should you post via?
598 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
599 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
600 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
601 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
602 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
606 * The Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
607 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
608 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
609 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
610 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
611 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
612 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
616 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
617 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
618 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
619 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
620 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
621 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
622 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
626 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
627 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
631 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
632 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
633 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
634 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
635 * Mail Backend Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
636 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
637 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
638 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
639 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
640 * Washing Mail:: Removing gruft from the mail you get.
641 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
642 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail backends for reading other files.
643 * Choosing a Mail Backend:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
647 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
648 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
649 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
651 Choosing a Mail Backend
653 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
654 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
655 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
656 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like backend.
657 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
658 * Comparing Mail Backends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
662 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
663 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
664 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
665 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
669 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
670 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
671 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
672 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
673 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
674 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
678 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
682 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
683 * SOUP Groups:: A backend for reading @sc{soup} packets.
684 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
688 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
689 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
690 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
694 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
695 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
699 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
700 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
701 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
702 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
703 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
704 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
705 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
706 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
707 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
708 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
712 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
713 * The Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
714 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
718 * Group Agent Commands::
719 * Summary Agent Commands::
720 * Server Agent Commands::
724 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
725 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
726 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
727 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
728 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
729 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
730 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
731 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
732 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
733 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
734 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
735 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
736 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
737 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
738 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
739 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
743 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
744 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
745 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
746 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
750 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
751 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
752 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
756 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
757 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
758 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
759 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
760 * Windows Configuration:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
761 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
762 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
763 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
764 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
765 * Buttons:: Get tendonitis in ten easy steps!
766 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
767 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
768 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
769 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
770 * XEmacs Enhancements:: There are more pictures and stuff under XEmacs.
771 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
772 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
773 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
777 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
778 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
779 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
780 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
781 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
785 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what your reading.
786 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
787 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
788 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
792 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
793 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
794 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
795 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
796 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
800 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
801 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
802 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
803 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
804 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
805 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
806 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
807 * Frequently Asked Questions:: A question-and-answer session.
811 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
812 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
813 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
814 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
815 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
816 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
817 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
818 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
819 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
820 * Newest Features:: Features so new that they haven't been written yet.
824 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
825 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.3/5.3.
826 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
827 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
831 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
832 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
833 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
834 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
838 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
839 * Backend Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
840 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
841 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
842 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
843 * Group Info:: The group info format.
844 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
845 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
846 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
850 * Required Backend Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
851 * Optional Backend Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
852 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
853 * Writing New Backends:: Extending old backends.
854 * Hooking New Backends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
855 * Mail-like Backends:: Some tips on mail backends.
859 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
860 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
864 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
865 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
871 @chapter Starting Gnus
876 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
877 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
880 @findex gnus-other-frame
881 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
882 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
883 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
885 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
886 variables in your @file{~/.gnus} file. This file is similar to
887 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when gnus starts.
889 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
890 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
893 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
894 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
895 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
896 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
897 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
898 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
899 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
900 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
901 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
902 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
903 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
907 @node Finding the News
908 @section Finding the News
911 @vindex gnus-select-method
913 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
914 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
915 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
916 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
919 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @sc{nntp} server is where
920 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
923 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
926 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
929 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
932 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
933 certainly be much faster.
935 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
937 @cindex @sc{nntp} server
938 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
939 @code{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
940 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
941 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter. If
942 that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs as an @sc{nntp} server. That's a long shot, though.
944 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
945 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
946 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
947 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
949 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
950 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
951 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
952 @sc{nntp} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
953 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
954 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
955 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
956 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
957 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
960 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
962 However, if you use one @sc{nntp} server regularly and are just
963 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
964 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
965 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
966 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
967 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
969 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
971 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
972 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
973 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
974 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
975 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
976 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
979 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} backend to read your mail, you
980 would typically set this variable to
983 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
988 @section The First Time
989 @cindex first time usage
991 If no startup files exist, Gnus will try to determine what groups should
992 be subscribed by default.
994 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
995 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
996 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
997 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1000 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1001 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1002 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1004 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1005 help you with most common problems.
1007 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1008 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1012 @node The Server is Down
1013 @section The Server is Down
1014 @cindex server errors
1016 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1017 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1018 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1020 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1021 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1022 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1023 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1024 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1025 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1026 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1028 @findex gnus-no-server
1029 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1031 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1032 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1033 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1034 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1035 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1036 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1041 @section Slave Gnusae
1044 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1045 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1046 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1047 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1049 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1050 @code{.newsrc} file.
1052 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1053 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1054 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1055 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1056 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1057 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1058 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1060 Anyways, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1061 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1062 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1063 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1064 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1065 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1066 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1067 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1069 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1070 information in the normal (i.e., master) @code{.newsrc} file.
1073 @node Fetching a Group
1074 @section Fetching a Group
1075 @cindex fetching a group
1077 @findex gnus-fetch-group
1078 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
1079 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
1080 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
1081 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
1082 It takes the group name as a parameter.
1088 @cindex subscription
1090 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1091 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1092 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1093 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1094 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1095 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1096 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1097 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the backends for new groups even
1098 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1101 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1102 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1103 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1107 @node Checking New Groups
1108 @subsection Checking New Groups
1110 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1111 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1112 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1113 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1114 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1115 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1116 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1117 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1118 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1119 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1121 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1122 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1123 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1124 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1125 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1126 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1127 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1128 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1129 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1130 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1131 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1133 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1134 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1135 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1136 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1137 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1138 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1141 @node Subscription Methods
1142 @subsection Subscription Methods
1144 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1145 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1146 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1148 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1149 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1151 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1155 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1156 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1157 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1158 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1159 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1161 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1162 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1163 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1164 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1166 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1167 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1168 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1170 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1171 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1172 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1173 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1174 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1175 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1176 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1177 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1178 up. Or something like that.
1180 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1181 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1182 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1183 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1184 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1186 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1187 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1188 Kill all new groups.
1190 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1191 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1192 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1193 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1194 topic parameter that looks like
1200 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1203 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1208 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1209 A closely related variable is
1210 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1211 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1212 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1213 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1216 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1217 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1218 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1219 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1222 @node Filtering New Groups
1223 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1225 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1226 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1227 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1230 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1233 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1234 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1235 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1236 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1237 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1238 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1239 subscribing these groups.
1240 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1241 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1243 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1244 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1245 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1246 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1247 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1248 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1249 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1250 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1252 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1253 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1254 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1255 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous, but I
1256 thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is more
1257 meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is used
1258 more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new groups
1259 that come from mail backends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1260 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, and @code{nnmh}) subscribed. If you
1261 don't like that, just set this variable to @code{nil}.
1263 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1264 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1267 @node Changing Servers
1268 @section Changing Servers
1269 @cindex changing servers
1271 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @sc{nntp} server to another.
1272 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1273 very flaky and you want to use another.
1275 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1276 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1280 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1281 @sc{nntp} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1282 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1283 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1286 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1287 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1288 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1289 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1291 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1292 @findex gnus-change-server
1293 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1294 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1295 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1296 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1297 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1299 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1300 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1301 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1302 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1303 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1305 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1306 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1307 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1308 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1309 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1310 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1312 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1313 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1314 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1318 @section Startup Files
1319 @cindex startup files
1324 Now, you all know about the @file{.newsrc} file. All subscription
1325 information is traditionally stored in this file.
1327 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1328 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1329 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1330 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1331 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1332 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1333 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1335 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1336 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1337 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1338 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1339 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1340 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1342 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1343 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1344 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1345 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1346 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1347 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1348 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1349 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1350 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which is
1351 convenient if you have a tendency to use Netscape once in a while.
1353 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1354 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1355 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1356 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1357 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1358 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1359 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1360 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1361 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1362 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1363 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1364 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1366 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1367 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1368 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1369 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1371 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1372 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1373 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1374 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1375 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1376 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1377 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1378 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1379 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1380 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1383 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1384 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1386 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1387 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1390 @vindex gnus-init-file
1391 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1392 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1393 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1394 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1395 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1396 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1397 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1398 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1399 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
1405 @cindex dribble file
1408 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1409 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1410 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1411 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1412 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1415 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1416 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1419 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1420 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1421 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1423 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1424 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1425 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1426 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1427 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1428 file permissions as the @code{.newsrc} file.
1430 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1431 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1432 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1435 @node The Active File
1436 @section The Active File
1438 @cindex ignored groups
1440 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1441 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1442 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1444 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1445 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1446 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1447 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1448 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1449 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1450 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1453 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1454 @c if you set it to anything else.
1456 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1458 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1459 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1460 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1462 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1463 you actually subscribe to.
1465 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1466 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1467 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1468 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1470 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1471 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1472 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1473 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1474 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1475 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1477 Some news servers (Leafnode and old versions of INN, for instance) do
1478 not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these servers, @code{nil}
1479 is probably the most efficient value for this variable.
1481 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1482 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1483 @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1484 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1485 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1486 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1488 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1489 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1491 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1492 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1494 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1495 secondary select methods.
1498 @node Startup Variables
1499 @section Startup Variables
1503 @item gnus-load-hook
1504 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1505 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1506 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1507 times you start Gnus.
1509 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1510 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1511 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1513 @item gnus-startup-hook
1514 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1515 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1517 @item gnus-started-hook
1518 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1519 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1522 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1523 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1524 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1525 generating the group buffer.
1527 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1528 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1529 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1530 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1531 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1532 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1533 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1534 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1536 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1537 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1538 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1539 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1540 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1541 @file{.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @code{.emacs} instead.
1543 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1544 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1545 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1547 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1548 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1549 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1551 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1552 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1553 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1554 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1559 @node The Group Buffer
1560 @chapter The Group Buffer
1561 @cindex group buffer
1563 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1564 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1565 long as Gnus is active.
1569 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1570 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group.ps,height=9cm}}
1571 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1572 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1573 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1574 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1575 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1576 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1582 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1583 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1584 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1585 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1586 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1587 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1588 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1589 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1590 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1591 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1592 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1593 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1594 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1595 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1596 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1597 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1598 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1602 @node Group Buffer Format
1603 @section Group Buffer Format
1606 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1607 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
1608 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1612 @node Group Line Specification
1613 @subsection Group Line Specification
1614 @cindex group buffer format
1616 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1617 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1619 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1622 25: news.announce.newusers
1623 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1628 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1629 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1630 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1631 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1633 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1634 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1635 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1636 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1637 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1638 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1640 @samp{%M%S%5y: %(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1642 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1643 the colon after performing an operation. Nothing else is required---not
1644 even the group name. All displayed text is just window dressing, and is
1645 never examined by Gnus. Gnus stores all real information it needs using
1648 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1649 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1650 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1652 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1657 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1660 Whether the group is subscribed.
1663 Level of subscribedness.
1666 Number of unread articles.
1669 Number of dormant articles.
1672 Number of ticked articles.
1675 Number of read articles.
1678 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1679 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1682 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1685 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1694 Newsgroup description.
1697 @samp{m} if moderated.
1700 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1709 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1713 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1716 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1717 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1718 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1719 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1720 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1723 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1725 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1729 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1733 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1734 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1735 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1736 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1737 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1738 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1743 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1744 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1745 group, or a bogus native group.
1748 @node Group Modeline Specification
1749 @subsection Group Modeline Specification
1750 @cindex group modeline
1752 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1753 The mode line can be changed by setting
1754 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1755 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1759 The native news server.
1761 The native select method.
1765 @node Group Highlighting
1766 @subsection Group Highlighting
1767 @cindex highlighting
1768 @cindex group highlighting
1770 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1771 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1772 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1773 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1774 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1776 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1780 (cond (window-system
1781 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1782 (defface my-group-face-1
1783 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1784 (defface my-group-face-2
1785 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t))) "Second group face")
1786 (defface my-group-face-3
1787 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1788 (defface my-group-face-4
1789 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1790 (defface my-group-face-5
1791 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1793 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1794 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1795 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1796 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1797 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1798 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1801 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1803 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1810 The number of unread articles in the group.
1814 Whether the group is a mail group.
1816 The level of the group.
1818 The score of the group.
1820 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1822 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather, MAX-NUMBER minus
1823 MIN-NUMBER plus one.
1825 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1826 topic being inserted.
1829 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1830 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1831 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1833 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1834 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1835 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1836 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1837 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1840 @node Group Maneuvering
1841 @section Group Maneuvering
1842 @cindex group movement
1844 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1845 expected, hopefully.
1851 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1852 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1853 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1859 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1860 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1861 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1865 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1866 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1870 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1871 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1875 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
1876 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
1877 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
1881 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
1882 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
1883 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
1886 Three commands for jumping to groups:
1892 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
1893 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
1894 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
1899 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
1900 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
1901 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
1905 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
1906 Jump to the first group with unread articles
1907 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
1910 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
1911 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
1912 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
1913 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
1917 @node Selecting a Group
1918 @section Selecting a Group
1919 @cindex group selection
1924 @kindex SPACE (Group)
1925 @findex gnus-group-read-group
1926 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
1927 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
1928 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
1929 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
1930 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{N}, @var{N}
1931 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{N} is
1932 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{N} newest articles, if @var{N} is
1933 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{N})} oldest articles.
1937 @findex gnus-group-select-group
1938 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
1939 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
1940 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
1941 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
1945 @kindex M-RET (Group)
1946 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
1947 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
1948 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
1949 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
1950 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
1951 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
1952 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
1953 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
1954 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
1957 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
1958 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
1959 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
1960 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
1961 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
1964 @kindex M-C-RET (Group)
1965 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
1966 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
1967 doing any processing of its contents
1968 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
1969 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
1970 manner will have no permanent effects.
1974 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
1975 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should consider
1976 to be a big group. This is 200 by default. If the group has more
1977 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
1978 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many articles
1979 should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a negative
1980 number (@code{-n}), the @code{n} oldest articles will be fetched. If it
1981 is positive, the @code{n} articles that have arrived most recently will
1984 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
1985 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
1986 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} control whether any articles are selected
1987 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
1992 Don't select any articles when entering the group. Just display the
1993 full summary buffer.
1996 Select the first unread article when entering the group.
1999 Select the highest scored article in the group when entering the
2004 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2005 be called to place point on a subject line, and/or select some article.
2006 Useful functions include:
2009 @item gnus-summary-first-unread-subject
2010 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article, but
2011 don't select the article.
2013 @item gnus-summary-first-unread-article
2014 Select the first unread article.
2016 @item gnus-summary-best-unread-article
2017 Select the highest-scored unread article.
2021 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2022 binary group with Huge articles) you can set this variable to @code{nil}
2023 in @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2027 @node Subscription Commands
2028 @section Subscription Commands
2029 @cindex subscription
2037 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2038 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2039 Toggle subscription to the current group
2040 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2046 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2047 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2048 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2049 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2055 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2056 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2057 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2063 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2064 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2067 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2068 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2069 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2070 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2071 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2077 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2078 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2082 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2083 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2086 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2087 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2088 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2089 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2090 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2091 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2092 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2093 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2094 @file{.newsrc} file.
2098 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2108 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2109 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2110 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2111 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2112 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2113 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2118 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2119 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2120 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2124 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2125 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2126 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2128 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2129 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2130 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2131 If you have switched from one @sc{nntp} server to another, all your marks
2132 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2133 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2140 @section Group Levels
2144 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2145 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2146 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2147 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2148 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2150 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2156 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2157 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2158 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2159 prompted for a level.
2162 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2163 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2164 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2165 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2166 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2167 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2168 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2169 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2170 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2171 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2172 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2173 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2174 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2175 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2176 reasons of efficiency.
2178 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2179 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2181 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2182 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2183 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2184 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2185 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2186 groups are hidden, in a way.
2188 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2189 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2190 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2191 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2192 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2193 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2195 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2196 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2197 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2198 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2199 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2200 list of killed groups.)
2202 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2203 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2204 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2206 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2207 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2208 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2209 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2210 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2211 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2212 relevant valid ranges.
2214 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2215 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2216 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2217 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2218 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2219 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2222 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2223 one with the best level.
2225 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2226 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2227 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2230 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2231 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2232 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2233 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2236 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2237 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2238 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2239 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2241 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2242 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2243 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2244 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2245 to 5. The default is 6.
2249 @section Group Score
2254 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2255 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2256 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2259 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2260 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2261 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2262 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2263 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2264 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2265 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2266 least significant part.))
2268 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2269 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2270 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2271 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2272 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2273 action after each summary exit, you can add
2274 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2275 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2276 slow things down somewhat.
2279 @node Marking Groups
2280 @section Marking Groups
2281 @cindex marking groups
2283 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2284 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2285 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2286 bidding on those groups.
2288 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2289 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2290 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2298 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2299 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2305 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2306 Remove the mark from the current group
2307 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2311 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2312 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2316 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2317 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2321 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2322 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2326 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2327 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2328 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2331 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2333 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2334 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2335 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2336 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2337 the command to be executed.
2340 @node Foreign Groups
2341 @section Foreign Groups
2342 @cindex foreign groups
2344 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2345 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2346 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2347 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2354 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2355 @cindex making groups
2356 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2357 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2358 to subscribe to @sc{nntp} groups, @pxref{Browse Foreign Server}.
2362 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2363 @cindex renaming groups
2364 Rename the current group to something else
2365 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2366 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2372 @findex gnus-group-customize
2373 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2377 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2378 @cindex renaming groups
2379 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2380 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2384 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2385 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2386 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2390 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2391 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2392 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2396 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2398 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2399 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2404 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2405 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2409 @cindex (ding) archive
2410 @cindex archive group
2411 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2412 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2413 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2414 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2415 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2416 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2417 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2421 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2423 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2424 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2425 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2426 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2430 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2432 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2433 @code{nneething} backend (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2434 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2438 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2439 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2441 Make a group based on some file or other
2442 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2443 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2444 Currently supported types are @code{babyl}, @code{mbox}, @code{digest},
2445 @code{mmdf}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{clari-briefs},
2446 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{nsmail} and @code{forward}.
2447 If you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2448 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2452 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2453 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2454 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2455 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2459 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2464 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2465 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2466 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2467 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2468 include @code{dejanews}, @code{altavista} and @code{reference}.
2469 @xref{Web Searches}.
2471 If you use the @code{dejanews} search engine, you can limit the search
2472 to a particular group by using a match string like
2473 @samp{~g alt.sysadmin.recovery shaving}.
2476 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2477 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2478 This function will delete the current group
2479 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2480 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2481 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2482 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2483 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} group), though.
2487 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2488 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2489 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2493 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2494 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2495 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2498 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2501 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2502 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2503 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2504 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2505 groups from different @sc{nntp} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2506 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2510 @node Group Parameters
2511 @section Group Parameters
2512 @cindex group parameters
2514 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2515 Here's an example group parameter list:
2518 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2522 We see that each element consists of a "dotted pair"---the thing before
2523 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2524 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2525 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2527 The following group parameters can be used:
2532 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2535 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2538 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2539 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2540 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2541 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2542 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2544 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2545 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2546 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2547 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2548 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2549 list address instead.
2553 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2556 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2559 It is totally ignored
2560 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2561 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2563 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2564 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2565 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2566 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2567 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2569 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you don't have a
2570 @code{to-list} group parameter, one will be added automatically upon
2571 sending the message.
2575 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2576 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2577 of whether it has any unread articles.
2579 @item broken-reply-to
2580 @cindex broken-reply-to
2581 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2582 headers in this group are to be ignored. This can be useful if you're
2583 reading a mailing list group where the listserv has inserted
2584 @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv itself. This is
2585 broken behavior. So there!
2589 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2590 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2594 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2595 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2596 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2601 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2602 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2603 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2604 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2605 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2606 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2607 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2611 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2612 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2613 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2616 @cindex total-expire
2617 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2618 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2619 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2620 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2625 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2626 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(expiry-wait
2627 . 10)}, this value will override any @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and
2628 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} when expiring expirable messages.
2629 The value can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or
2630 the symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2633 @cindex score file group parameter
2634 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2635 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2636 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2639 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2640 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2641 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2642 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2645 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2646 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2647 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2648 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2651 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2652 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2656 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2659 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2664 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")}
2665 are arbitrary comments on the group. They are currently ignored by
2666 Gnus, but provide a place for you to store information on particular
2670 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2671 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2672 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2674 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2675 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2676 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2677 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2678 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2679 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2680 @code{eval}ed there.
2682 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function, if you'd like.
2683 If you want to hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put
2684 something like @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that
2685 group. @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the result of the
2686 @code{(ding)} form, but who cares?
2689 You can store additional posting style information for this group only
2690 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2691 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2692 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2693 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2695 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2696 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2697 like this in the group parameters:
2702 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2707 Use the @kbd{G p} command to edit group parameters of a group. You
2708 might also be interested in reading about topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
2712 @node Listing Groups
2713 @section Listing Groups
2714 @cindex group listing
2716 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
2724 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
2725 List all groups that have unread articles
2726 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
2727 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
2728 only lists groups of level five (i. e.,
2729 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
2736 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
2737 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
2738 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
2739 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
2740 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
2741 unsubscribed groups).
2745 @findex gnus-group-list-level
2746 List all unread groups on a specific level
2747 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
2748 with no unread articles.
2752 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
2753 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
2754 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
2755 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
2760 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
2761 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
2765 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
2766 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
2767 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
2771 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
2772 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
2776 @findex gnus-group-list-active
2777 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
2778 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
2779 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
2780 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
2781 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
2782 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
2783 Take the output with some grains of salt.
2787 @findex gnus-group-apropos
2788 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
2789 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
2793 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
2794 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
2795 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
2799 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
2800 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
2804 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
2805 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
2809 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
2810 @cindex visible group parameter
2811 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
2812 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
2813 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
2814 get the same effect.
2816 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
2817 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
2818 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
2819 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
2820 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
2823 @node Sorting Groups
2824 @section Sorting Groups
2825 @cindex sorting groups
2827 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
2828 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
2829 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
2830 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
2831 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
2832 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
2837 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2838 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2839 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
2841 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2842 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2843 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
2845 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
2846 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
2847 Sort by group level.
2849 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
2850 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
2851 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
2853 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2854 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2855 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
2856 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
2858 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2859 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2860 Sort by number of unread articles.
2862 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
2863 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
2864 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
2869 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
2870 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
2874 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
2875 some sorting criteria:
2879 @kindex G S a (Group)
2880 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
2881 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
2882 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
2885 @kindex G S u (Group)
2886 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
2887 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
2888 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
2891 @kindex G S l (Group)
2892 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
2893 Sort the group buffer by group level
2894 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
2897 @kindex G S v (Group)
2898 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
2899 Sort the group buffer by group score
2900 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2903 @kindex G S r (Group)
2904 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
2905 Sort the group buffer by group rank
2906 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2909 @kindex G S m (Group)
2910 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
2911 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by backend name
2912 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
2916 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
2917 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
2919 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
2920 commands will sort in reverse order.
2922 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
2926 @kindex G P a (Group)
2927 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
2928 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
2929 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
2932 @kindex G P u (Group)
2933 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
2934 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
2935 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
2938 @kindex G P l (Group)
2939 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
2940 Sort the groups by group level
2941 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
2944 @kindex G P v (Group)
2945 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
2946 Sort the groups by group score
2947 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2950 @kindex G P r (Group)
2951 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
2952 Sort the groups by group rank
2953 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2956 @kindex G P m (Group)
2957 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
2958 Sort the groups alphabetically by backend name
2959 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
2965 @node Group Maintenance
2966 @section Group Maintenance
2967 @cindex bogus groups
2972 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
2973 Find bogus groups and delete them
2974 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
2978 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
2979 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
2980 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
2981 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
2982 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
2986 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
2987 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
2988 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
2989 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}).
2992 @kindex C-c M-C-x (Group)
2993 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
2994 Run all articles in all groups through the expiry process
2995 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3000 @node Browse Foreign Server
3001 @section Browse Foreign Server
3002 @cindex foreign servers
3003 @cindex browsing servers
3008 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3009 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3010 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3011 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3014 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3015 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3016 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3017 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3019 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3024 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3025 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3029 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3030 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3033 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3034 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3035 Enter the current group and display the first article
3036 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3039 @kindex RET (Browse)
3040 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3041 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3045 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3046 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3047 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3053 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3054 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3058 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3059 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3060 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3065 @section Exiting Gnus
3066 @cindex exiting Gnus
3068 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3073 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3074 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3075 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3076 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3080 @findex gnus-group-exit
3081 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3082 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3086 @findex gnus-group-quit
3087 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3088 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3091 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3092 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3093 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3094 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3095 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3100 If you wish to completely unload Gnus and all its adherents, you can use
3101 the @code{gnus-unload} command. This command is also very handy when
3102 trying to customize meta-variables.
3107 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3108 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3109 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3115 @section Group Topics
3118 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3119 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3120 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3121 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3122 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3123 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3127 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3128 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group-topic.ps,height=9cm}}
3139 2: alt.religion.emacs
3142 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3144 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3145 13: comp.sources.unix
3148 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3150 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3151 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3152 is a toggling command.)
3154 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3155 dum... Nice tune, that... la la la... What, you're back? Yes, and now
3156 press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed under
3157 @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy? Hot and
3160 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3161 the hook for the group mode:
3164 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3168 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3169 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3170 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3171 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3172 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3176 @node Topic Variables
3177 @subsection Topic Variables
3178 @cindex topic variables
3180 Now, if you select a topic, it will fold/unfold that topic, which is
3181 really neat, I think.
3183 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3184 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3185 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3198 Number of groups in the topic.
3200 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3202 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3205 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3206 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3207 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3210 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3211 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3213 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3214 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3215 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3218 @node Topic Commands
3219 @subsection Topic Commands
3220 @cindex topic commands
3222 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3223 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3224 definitions slightly.
3230 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3231 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3232 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3236 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3237 Move the current group to some other topic
3238 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3239 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3243 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3244 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3248 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3249 Copy the current group to some other topic
3250 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3251 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3255 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3256 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3257 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3261 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3262 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3263 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3267 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3268 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3269 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3270 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3271 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3272 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3273 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3276 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3277 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3281 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3282 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3283 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3287 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3288 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3289 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3293 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3294 Toggle hiding empty topics
3295 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3299 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3300 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3301 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}).
3304 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3305 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3306 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3307 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}).
3311 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3313 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3314 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3315 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3316 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3319 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3320 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3321 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3322 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3326 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3328 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3329 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3330 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3331 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3332 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3333 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3336 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3337 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3338 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the expiry
3339 process (if any) (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}).
3343 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3344 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3345 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3349 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3350 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3351 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3356 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3357 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3360 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3361 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3362 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3366 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3367 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3368 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3372 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3373 @cindex group parameters
3374 @cindex topic parameters
3376 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3377 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3383 @subsection Topic Sorting
3384 @cindex topic sorting
3386 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3392 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3393 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3394 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3395 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3398 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3399 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3400 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3401 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3404 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3405 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3406 Sort the current topic by group level
3407 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3410 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3411 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3412 Sort the current topic by group score
3413 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3416 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3417 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3418 Sort the current topic by group rank
3419 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3422 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3423 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3424 Sort the current topic alphabetically by backend name
3425 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3429 @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group sorting.
3432 @node Topic Topology
3433 @subsection Topic Topology
3434 @cindex topic topology
3437 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3443 2: alt.religion.emacs
3446 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3448 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3449 13: comp.sources.unix
3452 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3453 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3454 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3459 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3460 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3464 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3465 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3466 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3467 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3468 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3469 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3471 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3472 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3473 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3476 @node Topic Parameters
3477 @subsection Topic Parameters
3478 @cindex topic parameters
3480 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent (and
3481 ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid topic
3482 parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
3484 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3489 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3490 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3491 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3496 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3497 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3498 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3499 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3505 2: alt.religion.emacs
3509 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3511 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3512 13: comp.sources.unix
3516 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3517 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3518 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3519 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
3520 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
3521 . "religion.SCORE")}.
3523 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
3524 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
3525 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
3526 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
3527 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
3529 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
3530 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
3531 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
3532 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
3533 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
3534 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
3535 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
3536 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
3539 @node Misc Group Stuff
3540 @section Misc Group Stuff
3543 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
3544 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
3545 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
3546 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
3553 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
3554 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
3555 @xref{The Server Buffer}.
3559 @findex gnus-group-post-news
3560 Post an article to a group (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a
3561 prefix, the current group name will be used as the default.
3565 @findex gnus-group-mail
3566 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}).
3570 Variables for the group buffer:
3574 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
3575 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
3576 is called after the group buffer has been
3579 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
3580 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3581 is called after the group buffer is
3582 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
3585 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
3586 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3587 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
3588 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
3590 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3591 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3592 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
3593 whether they are empty or not.
3595 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3596 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3597 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
3598 non-ASCII group names.
3602 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3603 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
3606 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3607 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3608 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
3609 It is used to show non-ASCII group names.
3613 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3614 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
3619 @node Scanning New Messages
3620 @subsection Scanning New Messages
3621 @cindex new messages
3622 @cindex scanning new news
3628 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
3629 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
3630 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
3631 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
3632 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
3633 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
3638 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
3639 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
3640 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
3641 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
3642 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
3643 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
3644 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
3646 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
3647 @cindex activating groups
3649 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
3650 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
3655 @findex gnus-group-restart
3656 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
3657 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
3658 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
3662 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
3663 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
3665 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
3666 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
3670 @node Group Information
3671 @subsection Group Information
3672 @cindex group information
3673 @cindex information on groups
3680 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
3681 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
3684 Try to fetch the FAQ for the current group
3685 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the FAQ from
3686 @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on a
3687 remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories. In
3688 that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
3689 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be used
3690 for fetching the file.
3692 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
3693 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
3697 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
3699 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
3700 @cindex describing groups
3701 @cindex group description
3702 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
3703 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
3704 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
3708 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
3709 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
3710 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
3717 @findex gnus-version
3718 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
3722 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
3723 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
3726 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
3729 @findex gnus-info-find-node
3730 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
3734 @node Group Timestamp
3735 @subsection Group Timestamp
3737 @cindex group timestamps
3739 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
3740 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
3741 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
3744 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
3747 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
3749 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
3750 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
3753 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3754 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
3757 This will result in lines looking like:
3760 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
3761 0: custom 19961002T012713
3764 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
3765 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
3769 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3770 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
3775 @subsection File Commands
3776 @cindex file commands
3782 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
3783 @vindex gnus-init-file
3784 @cindex reading init file
3785 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
3786 @file{~/.gnus}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
3790 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
3791 @cindex saving .newsrc
3792 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
3793 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
3794 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
3797 @c @kindex Z (Group)
3798 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
3799 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
3804 @node The Summary Buffer
3805 @chapter The Summary Buffer
3806 @cindex summary buffer
3808 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
3809 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
3811 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
3812 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
3814 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
3817 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
3818 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
3819 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
3820 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
3821 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
3822 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
3823 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
3824 * Threading:: How threads are made.
3825 * Sorting:: How articles and threads are sorted.
3826 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
3827 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
3828 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
3829 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
3830 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
3831 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
3832 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
3833 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
3834 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
3835 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
3836 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
3837 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
3838 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
3839 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
3840 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
3841 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
3842 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer.
3843 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
3844 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
3848 @node Summary Buffer Format
3849 @section Summary Buffer Format
3850 @cindex summary buffer format
3854 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
3855 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary.ps,width=7.5cm}}
3856 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-article.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
3862 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
3863 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
3864 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
3865 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
3868 @findex mail-extract-address-components
3869 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
3870 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
3871 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
3872 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
3873 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
3874 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
3875 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
3876 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
3877 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
3878 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
3881 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
3882 'mail-extract-address-components)
3885 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
3886 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
3887 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
3888 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
3891 @node Summary Buffer Lines
3892 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
3894 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
3895 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
3896 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
3897 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
3898 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3900 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%) %s\n}.
3902 The following format specification characters are understood:
3908 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
3909 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
3911 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
3912 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
3913 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
3915 Full @code{From} header.
3917 The name (from the @code{From} header).
3919 The name, code @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header
3920 (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
3922 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
3923 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
3924 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
3925 may be more thorough.
3927 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
3930 Number of lines in the article.
3932 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported in some
3933 methods (like nnfolder).
3935 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3937 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
3938 pushes everything after it off the screen).
3940 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
3941 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3943 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
3944 for adopted articles.
3946 One space for each thread level.
3948 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
3953 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
3954 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
3958 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
3960 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
3961 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
3962 default level. If the difference between
3963 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
3964 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
3972 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
3974 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
3980 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
3981 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
3983 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
3984 article has any children.
3990 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
3991 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
3992 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
3993 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
3994 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
3995 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
3998 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
3999 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4000 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4001 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4002 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4003 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4005 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4006 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4008 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4011 @node To From Newsgroups
4012 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4016 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4017 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4018 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4019 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4020 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4024 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4025 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4026 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4030 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4031 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4034 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4035 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4038 @findex gnus-extra-header
4039 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4040 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4041 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4044 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4048 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4049 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4050 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4051 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4052 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4053 headers are used instead.
4057 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4058 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4059 to include extra headers when generating overview (@sc{nov}) files. If
4060 you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after changing
4063 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4064 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4065 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4066 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4068 In summary, you'd typically do something like the following:
4071 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4073 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4074 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4075 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20f%]%) %s\n")
4076 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4080 Now, this is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4081 the @sc{nov} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4088 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4089 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4092 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4093 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4095 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4096 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4097 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4098 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4100 Here are the elements you can play with:
4106 Unprefixed group name.
4108 Current article number.
4110 Current article score.
4114 Number of unread articles in this group.
4116 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4119 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4120 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4121 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4122 and no unselected ones.
4124 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4125 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4127 Subject of the current article.
4129 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4131 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4133 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4135 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4137 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4139 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4143 @node Summary Highlighting
4144 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4148 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4149 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4150 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4151 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4152 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4154 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4155 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4156 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4157 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4159 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4160 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4161 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4162 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4164 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4165 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4166 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4167 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4168 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4169 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4172 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4173 ((> score default) . bold))
4175 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4176 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4180 @node Summary Maneuvering
4181 @section Summary Maneuvering
4182 @cindex summary movement
4184 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4185 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4187 None of these commands select articles.
4192 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4193 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4194 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4195 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4196 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4200 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4201 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4202 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4203 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4204 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4209 @kindex G j (Summary)
4210 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
4211 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
4212 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
4215 @kindex G g (Summary)
4216 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4217 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4218 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4221 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4222 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4223 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4224 to the group buffer.
4226 Variables related to summary movement:
4230 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4231 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4232 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4233 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4234 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4235 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4236 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4237 next group, no matter whether it has any unread articles or not. As a
4238 special case, if this variable is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the
4239 next group without asking for confirmation. If this variable is
4240 @code{almost-quietly}, the same will happen only if you are located on
4241 the last article in the group. Finally, if this variable is
4242 @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n} command will go to the next group
4243 without confirmation. Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
4245 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4246 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4247 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4248 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4249 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4250 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4251 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4253 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4255 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4256 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4257 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4258 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4259 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4261 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4262 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4263 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4264 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4265 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4266 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4267 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4268 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4271 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4272 the given number of lines from the top.
4277 @node Choosing Articles
4278 @section Choosing Articles
4279 @cindex selecting articles
4282 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4283 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4287 @node Choosing Commands
4288 @subsection Choosing Commands
4290 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4291 and they all select and display an article.
4295 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4296 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4297 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4298 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4303 @kindex G n (Summary)
4304 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
4305 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
4306 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4311 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
4312 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
4313 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
4318 @kindex G N (Summary)
4319 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
4320 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
4325 @kindex G P (Summary)
4326 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
4327 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
4330 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
4331 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
4332 Go to the next article with the same subject
4333 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
4336 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
4337 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
4338 Go to the previous article with the same subject
4339 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
4343 @kindex G f (Summary)
4345 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
4346 Go to the first unread article
4347 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
4351 @kindex G b (Summary)
4353 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
4354 Go to the article with the highest score
4355 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}).
4360 @kindex G l (Summary)
4361 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
4362 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
4365 @kindex G o (Summary)
4366 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
4368 @cindex article history
4369 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
4370 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
4371 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
4372 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
4373 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
4374 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
4378 @node Choosing Variables
4379 @subsection Choosing Variables
4381 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
4384 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4385 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4386 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
4387 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
4388 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
4389 the server and display it in the article buffer.
4391 @item gnus-select-article-hook
4392 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
4393 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
4394 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article.
4396 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
4397 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
4398 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
4399 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
4400 @findex gnus-unread-mark
4401 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
4402 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
4403 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
4404 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
4405 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
4406 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
4407 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
4408 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
4409 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
4414 @node Paging the Article
4415 @section Scrolling the Article
4416 @cindex article scrolling
4421 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4422 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4423 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
4424 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
4425 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4428 @kindex DEL (Summary)
4429 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
4430 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
4433 @kindex RET (Summary)
4434 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
4435 Scroll the current article one line forward
4436 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
4439 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
4440 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
4441 Scroll the current article one line backward
4442 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
4446 @kindex A g (Summary)
4448 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
4449 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4450 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
4451 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
4452 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
4453 the way it came from the server.
4455 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
4456 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
4457 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
4460 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4465 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
4470 @kindex A < (Summary)
4471 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
4472 Scroll to the beginning of the article
4473 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
4478 @kindex A > (Summary)
4479 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
4480 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
4484 @kindex A s (Summary)
4486 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
4487 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
4488 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
4492 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
4493 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
4498 @node Reply Followup and Post
4499 @section Reply, Followup and Post
4502 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
4503 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
4504 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
4505 * Canceling and Superseding:: ``Whoops, I shouldn't have called him that.''
4509 @node Summary Mail Commands
4510 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
4512 @cindex composing mail
4514 Commands for composing a mail message:
4520 @kindex S r (Summary)
4522 @findex gnus-summary-reply
4523 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
4524 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
4525 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
4526 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
4531 @kindex S R (Summary)
4532 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
4533 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
4534 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
4535 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
4536 command uses the process/prefix convention.
4539 @kindex S w (Summary)
4540 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
4541 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
4542 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
4543 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
4544 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers.
4547 @kindex S W (Summary)
4548 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
4549 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
4550 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
4551 the process/prefix convention.
4555 @kindex S o m (Summary)
4556 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
4557 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
4558 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
4559 Forward the current article to some other person
4560 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
4561 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
4562 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
4563 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, foward message
4564 as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
4565 forward as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 4, foward message
4566 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
4567 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
4568 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 MIME section.
4573 @kindex S m (Summary)
4574 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
4575 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
4576 Send a mail to some other person
4577 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}).
4580 @kindex S D b (Summary)
4581 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
4582 @cindex bouncing mail
4583 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
4584 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
4585 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
4586 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
4587 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
4588 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
4589 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
4590 very well fail, though.
4593 @kindex S D r (Summary)
4594 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
4595 Not to be confused with the previous command,
4596 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
4597 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
4598 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
4599 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
4600 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
4601 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
4602 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
4604 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
4605 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
4606 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
4607 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
4608 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muß sein!
4610 This command understands the process/prefix convention
4611 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4614 @kindex S O m (Summary)
4615 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
4616 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
4617 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
4618 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4621 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
4622 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
4623 @cindex crossposting
4624 @cindex excessive crossposting
4625 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
4626 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
4628 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
4629 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
4630 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
4631 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
4632 command understands the process/prefix convention
4633 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
4637 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
4640 @node Summary Post Commands
4641 @subsection Summary Post Commands
4643 @cindex composing news
4645 Commands for posting a news article:
4651 @kindex S p (Summary)
4652 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
4653 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
4654 Post an article to the current group
4655 (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}).
4660 @kindex S f (Summary)
4661 @findex gnus-summary-followup
4662 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
4663 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
4667 @kindex S F (Summary)
4669 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
4670 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
4671 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
4672 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
4673 process/prefix convention.
4676 @kindex S n (Summary)
4677 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
4678 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
4679 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
4682 @kindex S N (Summary)
4683 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
4684 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
4685 message through mail and include the original message
4686 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
4687 the process/prefix convention.
4690 @kindex S o p (Summary)
4691 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
4692 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
4693 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
4694 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
4695 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
4696 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
4697 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, foward message
4698 as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
4699 forward as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 4, foward message
4700 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
4701 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
4702 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 MIME section.
4705 @kindex S O p (Summary)
4706 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
4708 @cindex making digests
4709 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
4710 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
4711 process/prefix convention.
4714 @kindex S u (Summary)
4715 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
4716 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
4717 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
4718 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
4721 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
4724 @node Summary Message Commands
4725 @subsection Summary Message Commands
4729 @kindex S y (Summary)
4730 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
4731 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
4732 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
4733 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
4734 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4739 @node Canceling and Superseding
4740 @subsection Canceling Articles
4741 @cindex canceling articles
4742 @cindex superseding articles
4744 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
4745 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
4747 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
4749 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
4751 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
4752 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
4753 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
4754 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
4755 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
4756 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4758 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
4759 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
4762 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
4763 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
4764 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
4766 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
4767 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
4768 your original article.
4770 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
4772 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
4773 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
4774 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
4777 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
4778 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
4779 have posted almost the same article twice.
4781 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
4782 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
4783 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
4784 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
4785 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
4786 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
4787 header by substituting one of those words for the word
4788 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
4789 you would do normally. The previous article will be
4790 canceled/superseded.
4792 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
4795 @node Marking Articles
4796 @section Marking Articles
4797 @cindex article marking
4798 @cindex article ticking
4801 There are several marks you can set on an article.
4803 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
4804 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
4805 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
4807 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
4810 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
4811 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
4812 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
4816 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks:
4820 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
4821 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
4822 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
4826 @node Unread Articles
4827 @subsection Unread Articles
4829 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
4834 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
4835 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
4837 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
4838 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
4839 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
4840 tick it. However, articles can be expired, so if you want to keep an
4841 article forever, you'll have to make it persistent (@pxref{Persistent
4845 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
4846 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
4848 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
4849 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
4850 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
4853 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
4854 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
4856 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
4861 @subsection Read Articles
4862 @cindex expirable mark
4864 All the following marks mark articles as read.
4869 @vindex gnus-del-mark
4870 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
4871 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
4874 @vindex gnus-read-mark
4875 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
4878 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
4879 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
4880 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
4883 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
4884 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
4887 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
4888 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
4891 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
4892 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
4895 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
4896 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
4899 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
4900 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
4903 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
4904 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
4907 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
4908 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
4912 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
4913 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
4914 (@code{gnus-duplicated-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4918 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
4919 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
4921 One more special mark, though:
4925 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
4926 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
4928 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
4929 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
4930 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
4931 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
4937 @subsection Other Marks
4938 @cindex process mark
4941 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
4947 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
4948 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
4949 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
4950 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
4951 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
4954 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
4955 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
4956 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
4957 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
4960 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
4961 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
4962 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
4965 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
4966 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
4967 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
4968 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
4971 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
4972 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
4973 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
4974 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
4975 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
4978 @vindex gnus-process-mark
4979 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
4980 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
4981 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
4982 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
4983 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
4987 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
4988 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
4989 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
4991 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
4992 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
4993 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
4997 @subsection Setting Marks
4998 @cindex setting marks
5000 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5005 @kindex M c (Summary)
5006 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5007 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5008 @cindex mark as unread
5009 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5010 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5016 @kindex M t (Summary)
5017 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5018 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5019 @xref{Article Caching}.
5024 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5025 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5026 Mark the current article as dormant
5027 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5031 @kindex M d (Summary)
5033 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5034 Mark the current article as read
5035 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5039 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5040 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5041 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5046 @kindex M k (Summary)
5047 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5048 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5049 and then select the next unread article
5050 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5054 @kindex M K (Summary)
5055 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5056 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5057 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5058 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5061 @kindex M C (Summary)
5062 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5063 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5064 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5067 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5068 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5069 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5070 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5073 @kindex M H (Summary)
5074 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5075 Catchup the current group to point
5076 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5079 @kindex C-w (Summary)
5080 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
5081 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
5082 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
5085 @kindex M V k (Summary)
5086 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
5087 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
5088 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
5092 @kindex M e (Summary)
5094 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
5095 Mark the current article as expirable
5096 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
5099 @kindex M b (Summary)
5100 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
5101 Set a bookmark in the current article
5102 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
5105 @kindex M B (Summary)
5106 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
5107 Remove the bookmark from the current article
5108 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
5111 @kindex M V c (Summary)
5112 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
5113 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
5114 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5117 @kindex M V u (Summary)
5118 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
5119 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
5120 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
5123 @kindex M V m (Summary)
5124 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
5125 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
5126 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
5127 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5130 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
5131 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
5132 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
5133 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
5134 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
5135 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
5136 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
5137 The default is @code{t}.
5140 @node Generic Marking Commands
5141 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
5143 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
5144 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
5145 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
5146 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
5147 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
5150 Multiply these five behaviours with five different marking commands, and
5151 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
5154 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
5155 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
5156 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
5157 to list in this manual.
5159 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
5160 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
5161 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
5162 article, you could say something like:
5165 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
5166 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5167 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
5173 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5174 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
5178 @node Setting Process Marks
5179 @subsection Setting Process Marks
5180 @cindex setting process marks
5187 @kindex M P p (Summary)
5188 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
5189 Mark the current article with the process mark
5190 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
5191 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
5195 @kindex M P u (Summary)
5196 @kindex M-# (Summary)
5197 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
5198 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
5201 @kindex M P U (Summary)
5202 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
5203 Remove the process mark from all articles
5204 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
5207 @kindex M P i (Summary)
5208 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
5209 Invert the list of process marked articles
5210 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
5213 @kindex M P R (Summary)
5214 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
5215 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5216 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
5219 @kindex M P G (Summary)
5220 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
5221 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5222 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
5225 @kindex M P r (Summary)
5226 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
5227 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
5230 @kindex M P t (Summary)
5231 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
5232 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5233 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
5236 @kindex M P T (Summary)
5237 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
5238 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5239 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
5242 @kindex M P v (Summary)
5243 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
5244 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
5245 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
5248 @kindex M P s (Summary)
5249 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
5250 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5253 @kindex M P S (Summary)
5254 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
5255 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
5256 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
5259 @kindex M P a (Summary)
5260 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
5261 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5264 @kindex M P b (Summary)
5265 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
5266 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
5267 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
5270 @kindex M P k (Summary)
5271 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
5272 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
5273 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
5276 @kindex M P y (Summary)
5277 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
5278 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
5279 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
5282 @kindex M P w (Summary)
5283 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
5284 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
5285 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
5289 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @pxref{Searching for Articles} for how to
5290 set process marks based on article body contents.
5297 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
5298 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
5299 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
5302 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
5303 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
5304 additional articles.
5310 @kindex / / (Summary)
5311 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
5312 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
5313 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}).
5316 @kindex / a (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
5318 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
5319 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}).
5322 @kindex / x (Summary)
5323 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
5324 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
5325 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
5326 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}).
5330 @kindex / u (Summary)
5332 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
5333 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
5334 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
5335 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
5336 dormant articles will also be excluded.
5339 @kindex / m (Summary)
5340 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
5341 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
5342 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
5345 @kindex / t (Summary)
5346 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
5347 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
5348 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
5349 articles younger than that number of days.
5352 @kindex / n (Summary)
5353 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
5354 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
5355 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
5356 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5359 @kindex / w (Summary)
5360 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
5361 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
5362 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
5366 @kindex / v (Summary)
5367 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
5368 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
5369 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
5373 @kindex M S (Summary)
5374 @kindex / E (Summary)
5375 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
5376 Include all expunged articles in the limit
5377 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
5380 @kindex / D (Summary)
5381 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
5382 Include all dormant articles in the limit
5383 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
5386 @kindex / * (Summary)
5387 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
5388 Include all cached articles in the limit
5389 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
5392 @kindex / d (Summary)
5393 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
5394 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
5395 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
5398 @kindex / M (Summary)
5399 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
5400 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
5403 @kindex / T (Summary)
5404 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
5405 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
5408 @kindex / c (Summary)
5409 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
5410 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit
5411 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
5414 @kindex / C (Summary)
5415 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
5416 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
5417 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
5418 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
5426 @cindex article threading
5428 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
5429 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
5430 hierarchical fashion.
5432 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
5433 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
5434 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
5435 or simply missing. Weird news propagation excarcerbates the problem,
5436 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
5437 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
5438 @pxref{Customizing Threading}.
5440 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
5444 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
5447 A tree-like article structure.
5450 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
5453 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
5454 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
5455 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
5456 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
5457 called loose threads.
5459 @item thread gathering
5460 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
5462 @item sparse threads
5463 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
5464 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
5470 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
5471 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
5475 @node Customizing Threading
5476 @subsection Customizing Threading
5477 @cindex customizing threading
5480 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
5481 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
5482 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
5483 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
5488 @subsubsection Loose Threads
5491 @cindex loose threads
5494 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
5495 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
5496 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
5497 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
5498 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
5499 read or killed the root in a previous session.
5501 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
5502 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
5503 There are four possible values:
5507 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
5508 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-adopt.ps,width=7.5cm}}
5509 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-empty.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5510 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-none.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5511 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-dummy.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5516 @cindex adopting articles
5521 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
5522 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
5523 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
5524 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
5527 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
5528 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
5529 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
5530 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
5531 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
5532 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
5533 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
5536 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
5537 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
5538 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
5542 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
5543 display them after one another.
5546 Don't gather loose threads.
5549 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
5550 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
5551 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
5552 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
5553 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
5554 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
5555 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
5556 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
5557 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
5558 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
5559 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
5561 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
5562 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
5563 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
5566 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
5567 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
5568 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
5569 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
5570 simplification is used.
5572 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5573 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5574 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
5575 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
5577 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
5579 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5585 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
5586 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
5587 "answer" "reference" "announce"
5588 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
5593 (mapconcat 'identity
5594 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
5596 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
5599 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
5602 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
5603 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
5604 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
5605 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
5606 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
5607 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
5609 Useful functions to put in this list include:
5612 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
5613 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
5614 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
5616 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
5617 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
5620 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
5621 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
5622 Remove excessive whitespace.
5625 You may also write your own functions, of course.
5628 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
5629 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
5630 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
5631 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
5632 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
5633 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
5634 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
5635 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
5637 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5638 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5639 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
5640 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
5641 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
5642 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
5643 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
5644 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
5645 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
5649 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
5650 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
5651 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
5652 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
5654 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
5655 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
5656 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
5659 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
5663 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5664 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
5670 @node Filling In Threads
5671 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
5674 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
5675 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
5676 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
5677 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you
5678 would like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still
5679 connect as many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable
5680 to @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than
5681 that number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case,
5682 fetching old headers only works if the backend you are using carries
5683 overview files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and
5684 @code{nnml}. Also remember that if the root of the thread has been
5685 expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can do about that.
5687 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
5688 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
5689 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
5691 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
5692 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
5693 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
5694 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
5695 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
5696 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
5697 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
5698 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
5699 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
5700 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
5701 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
5702 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
5703 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
5704 @code{nil} by default.
5709 @node More Threading
5710 @subsubsection More Threading
5713 @item gnus-show-threads
5714 @vindex gnus-show-threads
5715 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
5716 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
5717 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
5718 slower and more awkward.
5720 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
5721 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
5722 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
5725 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
5726 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
5727 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
5728 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
5729 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
5730 threads are expunged.
5732 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
5733 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
5734 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
5737 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
5738 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
5739 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
5740 this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subject change is ignored. If it
5741 is @code{nil}, which is the default, a change in the subject will result
5744 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
5745 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
5746 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
5749 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
5750 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
5751 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
5752 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
5753 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
5754 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
5755 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
5756 Setting this variable to an alternate value
5757 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
5758 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
5759 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
5764 @node Low-Level Threading
5765 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
5769 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
5770 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
5771 Hook run before parsing any headers.
5773 @item gnus-alter-header-function
5774 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
5775 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
5776 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
5777 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
5778 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
5779 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
5780 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
5781 meaningful. Here's one example:
5784 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
5786 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
5787 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
5789 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
5791 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
5798 @node Thread Commands
5799 @subsection Thread Commands
5800 @cindex thread commands
5806 @kindex T k (Summary)
5807 @kindex M-C-k (Summary)
5808 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
5809 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
5810 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
5811 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
5816 @kindex T l (Summary)
5817 @kindex M-C-l (Summary)
5818 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
5819 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
5820 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
5823 @kindex T i (Summary)
5824 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
5825 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
5826 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
5829 @kindex T # (Summary)
5830 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
5831 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
5832 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
5835 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
5836 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
5837 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
5838 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
5841 @kindex T T (Summary)
5842 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
5843 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
5846 @kindex T s (Summary)
5847 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
5848 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any
5849 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
5852 @kindex T h (Summary)
5853 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
5854 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
5857 @kindex T S (Summary)
5858 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
5859 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
5862 @kindex T H (Summary)
5863 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
5864 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
5867 @kindex T t (Summary)
5868 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
5869 Re-thread the current article's thread
5870 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
5871 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
5874 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
5875 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
5876 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
5877 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
5881 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
5882 understand the numeric prefix.
5887 @kindex T n (Summary)
5889 @kindex M-C-n (Summary)
5891 @kindex M-down (Summary)
5892 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
5893 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
5896 @kindex T p (Summary)
5898 @kindex M-C-p (Summary)
5900 @kindex M-up (Summary)
5901 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
5902 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
5905 @kindex T d (Summary)
5906 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
5907 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
5910 @kindex T u (Summary)
5911 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
5912 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
5915 @kindex T o (Summary)
5916 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
5917 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
5920 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
5921 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
5922 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
5923 a command like `T k' (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
5924 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
5925 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
5926 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
5927 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
5928 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
5929 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
5930 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
5931 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
5938 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
5939 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
5940 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
5941 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
5942 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
5943 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
5944 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
5945 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
5946 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
5947 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
5948 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
5950 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
5951 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
5952 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
5953 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score}, and
5954 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
5956 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
5957 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
5958 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
5960 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
5961 last function in the list. You should probably always include
5962 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
5963 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
5964 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
5965 ascending article order.
5967 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
5968 by number, you could do something like:
5971 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
5972 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
5973 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
5974 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
5977 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
5978 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
5979 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
5980 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
5981 which the articles arrived.
5983 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
5987 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
5989 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
5990 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
5993 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
5994 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
5995 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
5996 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
5999 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
6000 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
6001 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
6002 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
6003 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
6004 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
6005 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or other,
6006 you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions} variable.
6007 It is very similar to the @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that
6008 it uses slightly different functions for article comparison. Available
6009 sorting predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
6010 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject},
6011 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date}, and @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
6013 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
6017 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
6018 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
6019 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
6024 @node Asynchronous Fetching
6025 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
6026 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
6027 @cindex article pre-fetch
6030 If you read your news from an @sc{nntp} server that's far away, the
6031 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
6032 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
6033 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
6034 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
6036 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
6037 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
6039 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
6040 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
6041 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
6042 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
6043 connection is blocked.
6045 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
6046 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
6047 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
6048 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
6050 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
6051 the link between your machine and the @sc{nntp} server will become more
6052 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
6053 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
6056 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing... unless
6059 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
6060 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
6061 happen automatically.
6063 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
6064 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
6065 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
6066 that when you read an article in the group, the backend will pre-fetch
6067 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the backend will
6068 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
6069 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
6071 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
6072 @findex gnus-async-read-p
6073 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
6074 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p} variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This function should
6075 return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is to be
6076 pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which returns
6077 @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an article
6078 data structure as the only parameter.
6080 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter than 100 lines, you could say something like:
6083 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
6084 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
6085 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
6086 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
6089 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
6092 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
6093 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
6094 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
6096 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
6097 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
6098 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
6099 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
6103 Remove articles when they are read.
6106 Remove articles when exiting the group.
6109 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
6111 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
6112 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
6113 @c from the next group.
6116 @node Article Caching
6117 @section Article Caching
6118 @cindex article caching
6121 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @sc{nntp} connection, you may
6122 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
6123 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
6124 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
6125 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
6127 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
6129 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
6130 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
6131 @vindex gnus-use-cache
6132 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
6133 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
6134 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
6135 cache is flat or hierarchal is controlled by the
6136 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
6138 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
6139 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
6140 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
6141 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
6142 as dormant, and don't worry.
6144 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
6146 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
6147 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
6148 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
6149 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
6150 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
6151 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
6152 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
6153 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
6154 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
6155 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
6157 @findex gnus-jog-cache
6158 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
6159 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
6160 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
6161 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
6162 command if 1) your connection to the @sc{nntp} server is really, really,
6163 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
6164 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
6165 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
6166 not then be downloaded by this command.
6168 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
6169 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
6170 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
6171 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
6172 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
6173 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
6175 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
6176 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
6177 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
6178 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
6179 variables, the group is not cached.
6181 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
6182 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
6183 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
6184 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
6185 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
6186 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
6187 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
6188 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @sc{nov}
6189 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
6193 @node Persistent Articles
6194 @section Persistent Articles
6195 @cindex persistent articles
6197 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
6198 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
6199 useful in my opinion.
6201 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
6202 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
6203 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
6204 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
6205 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
6206 the expiry going on at the news server.
6208 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
6209 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
6210 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
6216 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
6217 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
6220 @kindex M-* (Summary)
6221 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
6222 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
6223 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
6227 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
6229 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
6230 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
6231 interested in persistent articles:
6234 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
6238 @node Article Backlog
6239 @section Article Backlog
6241 @cindex article backlog
6243 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
6244 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
6245 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
6246 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
6247 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
6248 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
6249 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
6250 increase memory usage some.
6252 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
6253 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
6254 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
6255 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
6256 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
6257 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
6258 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
6260 This variable is @code{nil} by default.
6263 @node Saving Articles
6264 @section Saving Articles
6265 @cindex saving articles
6267 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
6268 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
6269 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
6270 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
6271 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
6273 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
6274 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
6275 unwanted headers before saving the article.
6277 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
6278 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
6279 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
6280 deleted before saving.
6286 @kindex O o (Summary)
6288 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
6289 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
6290 Save the current article using the default article saver
6291 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
6294 @kindex O m (Summary)
6295 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
6296 Save the current article in mail format
6297 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
6300 @kindex O r (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
6302 Save the current article in rmail format
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
6306 @kindex O f (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
6308 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
6309 Save the current article in plain file format
6310 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
6313 @kindex O F (Summary)
6314 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
6315 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
6316 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
6319 @kindex O b (Summary)
6320 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
6321 Save the current article body in plain file format
6322 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
6325 @kindex O h (Summary)
6326 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
6327 Save the current article in mh folder format
6328 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
6331 @kindex O v (Summary)
6332 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
6333 Save the current article in a VM folder
6334 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
6337 @kindex O p (Summary)
6338 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
6339 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
6340 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
6343 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
6344 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
6345 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
6346 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
6347 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
6348 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
6349 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
6350 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
6351 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
6352 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
6353 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
6354 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
6358 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
6359 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
6360 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
6361 functions below, or you can create your own.
6365 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
6366 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
6367 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
6368 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
6369 This is the default format, @dfn{babyl}. Uses the function in the
6370 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6371 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
6373 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
6374 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
6375 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
6376 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
6377 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6378 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
6380 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
6381 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
6382 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
6383 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
6384 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
6385 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6386 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
6388 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
6389 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
6390 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
6391 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6392 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
6394 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
6395 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
6396 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
6397 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
6398 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
6401 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
6402 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
6403 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
6404 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
6405 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
6407 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
6408 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
6409 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
6410 reader to use this setting.
6413 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
6414 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
6415 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
6416 @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
6419 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
6420 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
6421 available functions that generate names:
6425 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
6426 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
6427 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
6429 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
6430 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
6431 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
6433 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
6434 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
6435 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
6437 @item gnus-plain-save-name
6438 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
6439 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
6442 @vindex gnus-split-methods
6443 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
6444 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
6445 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
6446 related to VM in @code{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
6450 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
6451 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
6452 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
6453 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
6456 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
6457 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
6458 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
6459 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
6460 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
6461 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
6462 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
6463 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
6464 called returns a string or a list of strings.
6466 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
6467 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
6468 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
6469 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
6471 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
6472 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
6473 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
6476 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
6477 lots of mail groups called things like
6478 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
6479 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
6480 following will do just that:
6483 (defun my-save-name (group)
6484 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
6485 (substring group (match-end 0))))
6487 (setq gnus-split-methods
6488 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
6493 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
6494 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
6495 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
6496 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
6497 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
6498 all the files in the top level directory
6499 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
6500 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
6501 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
6502 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
6504 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
6505 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
6506 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
6507 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
6508 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
6511 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
6515 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; to get a hierarchy
6516 (setq gnus-default-article-saver 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; no encoding
6519 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
6520 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
6521 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
6522 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
6525 @node Decoding Articles
6526 @section Decoding Articles
6527 @cindex decoding articles
6529 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
6530 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
6533 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
6534 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
6535 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
6536 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
6537 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
6538 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
6542 @cindex article series
6543 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
6544 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
6545 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
6546 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
6547 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
6549 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
6550 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
6551 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
6553 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
6554 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
6555 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
6557 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
6558 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
6559 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
6562 @node Uuencoded Articles
6563 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
6565 @cindex uuencoded articles
6570 @kindex X u (Summary)
6571 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
6572 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
6573 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
6576 @kindex X U (Summary)
6577 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
6578 Uudecodes and saves the current series
6579 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
6582 @kindex X v u (Summary)
6583 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
6584 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
6587 @kindex X v U (Summary)
6588 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
6589 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
6590 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
6594 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
6595 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
6596 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
6597 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
6598 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
6600 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
6601 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
6602 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
6603 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
6606 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
6607 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
6608 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
6609 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
6610 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
6611 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
6615 @node Shell Archives
6616 @subsection Shell Archives
6618 @cindex shell archives
6619 @cindex shared articles
6621 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
6622 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
6623 some commands to deal with these:
6628 @kindex X s (Summary)
6629 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
6630 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
6633 @kindex X S (Summary)
6634 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
6635 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
6638 @kindex X v s (Summary)
6639 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
6640 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
6643 @kindex X v S (Summary)
6644 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
6645 Unshars, views and saves the current series
6646 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
6650 @node PostScript Files
6651 @subsection PostScript Files
6657 @kindex X p (Summary)
6658 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
6659 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
6662 @kindex X P (Summary)
6663 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
6664 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
6665 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
6668 @kindex X v p (Summary)
6669 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
6670 View the current PostScript series
6671 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
6674 @kindex X v P (Summary)
6675 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
6676 View and save the current PostScript series
6677 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
6682 @subsection Other Files
6686 @kindex X o (Summary)
6687 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
6688 Save the current series
6689 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
6692 @kindex X b (Summary)
6693 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
6694 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
6695 doesn't really work yet.
6699 @node Decoding Variables
6700 @subsection Decoding Variables
6702 Adjective, not verb.
6705 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
6706 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
6707 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
6711 @node Rule Variables
6712 @subsubsection Rule Variables
6713 @cindex rule variables
6715 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
6716 variables are of the form
6719 (list '(regexp1 command2)
6726 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6727 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6729 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
6730 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @samp{.au} sound file, you could
6733 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6734 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
6737 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
6738 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
6739 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
6740 user and default view rules.
6742 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
6743 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
6744 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
6749 @node Other Decode Variables
6750 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
6753 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
6755 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
6756 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
6757 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
6758 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
6759 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
6763 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
6764 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
6767 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
6768 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
6769 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
6772 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
6773 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
6774 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
6775 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
6776 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
6779 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
6780 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
6781 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
6783 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
6784 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
6785 Files with a @sc{mime} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
6786 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
6787 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @sc{mime} package (yet), so this is slightly
6790 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
6791 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
6792 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
6794 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
6795 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
6796 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
6797 looking for files to display.
6799 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
6800 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
6801 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
6804 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
6805 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
6806 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
6809 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
6810 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
6811 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
6814 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
6815 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
6816 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
6819 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
6820 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
6821 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
6822 decoded articles as unread.
6824 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
6825 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
6826 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
6827 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
6829 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
6830 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
6831 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
6833 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
6834 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
6836 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
6837 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @sc{mime}
6838 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
6839 @code{metamail} for viewing.
6841 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
6842 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
6843 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
6844 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
6845 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
6846 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
6847 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
6848 simply dropped them.
6853 @node Uuencoding and Posting
6854 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
6858 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
6859 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
6860 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
6861 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
6862 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
6863 for you when you post the article.
6865 @item gnus-uu-post-length
6866 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
6867 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
6868 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
6870 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
6871 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
6872 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
6873 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
6874 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
6875 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
6876 think that counts...) Default is @code{nil}.
6878 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6879 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6880 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
6881 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
6882 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
6883 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
6884 Default is @code{t}.
6890 @subsection Viewing Files
6891 @cindex viewing files
6892 @cindex pseudo-articles
6894 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
6895 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
6896 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
6897 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
6898 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
6899 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
6900 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
6902 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
6903 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
6904 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
6905 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
6907 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
6908 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
6909 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
6911 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
6912 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
6913 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
6914 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
6915 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
6917 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
6918 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
6919 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
6920 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
6921 a list of parameters to that command.
6923 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
6924 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
6925 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
6927 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
6928 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
6929 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
6932 @node Article Treatment
6933 @section Article Treatment
6935 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
6936 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
6937 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
6938 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
6939 these articles easier.
6942 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
6943 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
6944 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
6945 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
6946 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
6947 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
6948 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
6949 * Article Miscellania:: Various other stuff.
6953 @node Article Highlighting
6954 @subsection Article Highlighting
6955 @cindex highlighting
6957 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
6958 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
6963 @kindex W H a (Summary)
6964 @findex gnus-article-highlight
6965 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
6966 Do much highlighting of the current article
6967 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
6968 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
6971 @kindex W H h (Summary)
6972 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
6973 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
6974 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
6975 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
6976 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
6977 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
6978 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
6979 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
6980 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
6981 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
6982 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
6985 @kindex W H c (Summary)
6986 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
6987 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
6989 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
6992 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
6994 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
6995 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
6996 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
6998 @item gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
6999 @vindex gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
7000 Regexp matching the longest possible citation prefix on a line.
7002 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
7003 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
7004 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
7006 @item gnus-cite-face-list
7007 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
7008 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
7009 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
7010 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
7011 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
7013 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
7014 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
7015 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
7017 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7018 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7019 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
7021 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7022 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7023 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
7024 that it's a citation.
7026 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7027 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7028 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
7030 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7031 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7032 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
7034 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
7035 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
7036 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
7037 cited text belonging to the attribution.
7043 @kindex W H s (Summary)
7044 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
7045 @vindex gnus-signature-face
7046 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
7047 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
7048 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
7049 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
7050 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
7055 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
7058 @node Article Fontisizing
7059 @subsection Article Fontisizing
7061 @cindex article emphasis
7063 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
7064 @kindex W e (Summary)
7065 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
7066 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
7067 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
7068 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
7070 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
7071 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
7072 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
7073 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
7074 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
7075 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
7076 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
7077 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
7081 (setq gnus-article-emphasis
7082 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
7083 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
7092 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
7093 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
7094 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
7095 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
7096 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
7097 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
7098 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
7099 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
7100 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
7101 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
7102 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
7103 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
7104 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
7106 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
7107 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
7108 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
7112 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
7115 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
7117 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
7118 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
7119 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
7120 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
7122 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
7125 @node Article Hiding
7126 @subsection Article Hiding
7127 @cindex article hiding
7129 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
7130 too much cruft in most articles.
7135 @kindex W W a (Summary)
7136 @findex gnus-article-hide
7137 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
7138 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
7139 headers, PGP, cited text and the signature.
7142 @kindex W W h (Summary)
7143 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
7144 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
7148 @kindex W W b (Summary)
7149 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
7150 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
7151 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
7154 @kindex W W s (Summary)
7155 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
7156 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
7160 @kindex W W l (Summary)
7161 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
7162 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7163 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
7164 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
7165 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
7166 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
7167 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
7171 @item gnus-list-identifiers
7172 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7173 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
7174 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
7179 @kindex W W p (Summary)
7180 @findex gnus-article-hide-pgp
7181 @vindex gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7182 Hide @sc{pgp} signatures (@code{gnus-article-hide-pgp}). The
7183 @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook} hook will be run after a @sc{pgp}
7184 signature has been hidden. For example, to automatically verify
7185 articles that have signatures in them do:
7187 ;;; Hide pgp cruft if any.
7189 (setq gnus-treat-strip-pgp t)
7191 ;;; After hiding pgp, verify the message;
7192 ;;; only happens if pgp signature is found.
7194 (add-hook 'gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7197 (set-buffer gnus-original-article-buffer)
7202 @kindex W W P (Summary)
7203 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
7204 Hide @sc{pem} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
7205 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
7208 @kindex W W B (Summary)
7209 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
7212 @cindex stripping advertisments
7213 @cindex advertisments
7214 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
7215 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
7216 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
7217 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
7218 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
7219 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
7220 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
7221 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
7222 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
7223 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
7227 @kindex W W c (Summary)
7228 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
7229 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
7230 customizing the hiding:
7234 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7235 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7236 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7237 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7238 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
7239 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
7240 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
7245 Starting point of the hidden text.
7247 Ending point of the hidden text.
7249 Number of characters in the hidden region.
7251 Number of lines of hidden text.
7254 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
7255 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
7256 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
7257 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
7258 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
7263 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
7264 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
7266 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
7267 following two variables:
7270 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
7271 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
7272 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
7273 50), hide the cited text.
7275 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
7276 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
7277 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
7282 @kindex W W C (Summary)
7283 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
7284 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
7285 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
7286 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
7287 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
7291 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
7292 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
7293 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
7295 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
7296 citation customization.
7298 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
7302 @node Article Washing
7303 @subsection Article Washing
7305 @cindex article washing
7307 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
7308 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
7310 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
7311 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
7317 @kindex W l (Summary)
7318 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
7319 Remove page breaks from the current article
7320 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
7324 @kindex W r (Summary)
7325 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
7326 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
7327 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
7328 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
7329 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
7330 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
7332 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
7333 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
7334 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
7335 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
7339 @kindex W t (Summary)
7341 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
7342 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
7343 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
7346 @kindex W v (Summary)
7347 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-header
7348 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
7349 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-header}).
7352 @kindex W o (Summary)
7353 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
7354 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
7357 @kindex W d (Summary)
7358 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
7359 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
7361 @cindex M******** sm*rtq**t*s
7363 Treat M******** sm*rtq**t*s according to
7364 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
7365 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
7366 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
7370 @kindex W w (Summary)
7371 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
7372 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
7374 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
7378 @kindex W Q (Summary)
7379 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
7380 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
7383 @kindex W C (Summary)
7384 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
7385 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
7386 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
7389 @kindex W c (Summary)
7390 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
7391 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
7392 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
7393 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
7394 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
7397 @kindex W q (Summary)
7398 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
7399 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
7400 Quoted-Printable is one common @sc{mime} encoding employed when sending
7401 non-ASCII (i. e., 8-bit) articles. It typically makes strings like
7402 @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which doesn't look very
7403 readable to me. Note that the this is usually done automatically by
7404 Gnus if the message in question has a @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding}
7405 header that says that this encoding has been done.
7408 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
7409 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
7410 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}).
7411 Base64 is one common @sc{mime} encoding employed when sending non-ASCII
7412 (i. e., 8-bit) articles. Note that the this is usually done
7413 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
7414 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding has
7418 @kindex W Z (Summary)
7419 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
7420 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
7421 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
7422 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
7425 @kindex W h (Summary)
7426 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
7427 Treat HTML (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}).
7428 Note that the this is usually done automatically by Gnus if the message
7429 in question has a @code{Content-Type} header that says that this type
7433 @kindex W f (Summary)
7435 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
7436 @findex gnus-article-x-face-command
7437 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
7438 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
7444 Look for and display any X-Face headers
7445 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}). The command executed by this
7446 function is given by the @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable.
7447 If this variable is a string, this string will be executed in a
7448 sub-shell. If it is a function, this function will be called with the
7449 face as the argument. If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which
7450 is a regexp) matches the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
7451 The default action under Emacs is to fork off the @code{display}
7452 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For the
7453 @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
7454 like `compface' or `faces-xface' on a GNU/Linux system.}
7455 to view the face. Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image
7456 support, the default action is to display the face before the
7457 @code{From} header. (It's nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with X-Face
7458 support---that will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native
7459 X-Face support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
7460 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
7461 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
7462 like @code{netpbm} or @code{libgr-progs}.}) If you
7463 want to have this function in the display hook, it should probably come
7467 @kindex W b (Summary)
7468 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
7469 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
7470 @xref{Article Buttons}.
7473 @kindex W B (Summary)
7474 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
7475 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
7476 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
7479 @kindex W W H (Summary)
7480 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-from-body
7481 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
7482 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-from-body}).
7485 @kindex W E l (Summary)
7486 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
7487 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
7488 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
7491 @kindex W E m (Summary)
7492 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
7493 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
7494 lines with a single empty line.
7495 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
7498 @kindex W E t (Summary)
7499 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
7500 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
7501 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
7504 @kindex W E a (Summary)
7505 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
7506 Do all the three commands above
7507 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
7510 @kindex W E A (Summary)
7511 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
7512 Remove all blank lines
7513 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
7516 @kindex W E s (Summary)
7517 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
7518 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
7519 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
7522 @kindex W E e (Summary)
7523 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
7524 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
7525 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
7529 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
7532 @node Article Buttons
7533 @subsection Article Buttons
7536 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
7537 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
7538 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
7539 button on these references.
7541 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
7542 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses and Message-IDs. This is controlled by
7543 two variables, one that handles article bodies and one that handles
7548 @item gnus-button-alist
7549 @vindex gnus-button-alist
7550 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
7553 (REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
7559 All text that match this regular expression will be considered an
7560 external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches embedded URLs:
7561 @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}.
7564 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
7565 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
7566 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
7569 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
7570 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
7571 avoid false matches.
7574 This function will be called when you click on this button.
7577 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
7578 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
7582 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
7585 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
7588 @item gnus-header-button-alist
7589 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
7590 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
7591 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
7592 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
7595 (HEADER REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
7598 @var{header} is a regular expression.
7600 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
7601 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
7602 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
7603 default values of the variables above.
7605 @item gnus-article-button-face
7606 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
7607 Face used on buttons.
7609 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
7610 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
7611 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
7615 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
7619 @subsection Article Date
7621 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
7622 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
7623 when the article was sent.
7628 @kindex W T u (Summary)
7629 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
7630 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
7631 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
7634 @kindex W T i (Summary)
7635 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
7637 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
7638 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
7641 @kindex W T l (Summary)
7642 @findex gnus-article-date-local
7643 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
7646 @kindex W T s (Summary)
7647 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
7648 @findex gnus-article-date-user
7649 @findex format-time-string
7650 Display the date using a user-defined format
7651 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
7652 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
7653 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
7654 for a list of possible format specs.
7657 @kindex W T e (Summary)
7658 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
7659 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
7660 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
7661 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
7662 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
7665 X-Sent: 9 years, 6 weeks, 4 days, 9 hours, 3 minutes, 28 seconds ago
7668 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
7669 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
7672 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
7673 into wonderful absurdities.
7675 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
7678 (gnus-start-date-timer)
7681 in your @file{.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
7682 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
7686 @kindex W T o (Summary)
7687 @findex gnus-article-date-original
7688 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
7689 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
7690 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
7691 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
7692 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
7696 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
7697 preferred format automatically.
7700 @node Article Signature
7701 @subsection Article Signature
7703 @cindex article signature
7705 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
7706 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
7707 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
7708 that says what is to be considered a signature is
7709 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
7710 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
7711 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
7712 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
7713 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
7716 (setq gnus-signature-separator
7717 '("^-- $" ; The standard
7718 "^-- *$" ; A common mangling
7719 "^-------*$" ; Many people just use a looong
7720 ; line of dashes. Shame!
7721 "^ *--------*$" ; Double-shame!
7722 "^________*$" ; Underscores are also popular
7723 "^========*$")) ; Pervert!
7726 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
7729 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
7730 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
7731 signature when displaying articles.
7735 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
7738 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
7741 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
7742 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
7744 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
7745 in question is not a signature.
7748 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
7749 listed above. Here's an example:
7752 (setq gnus-signature-limit
7753 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
7756 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
7757 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
7758 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
7759 signature after all.
7762 @node Article Miscellania
7763 @subsection Article Miscellania
7767 @kindex A t (Summary)
7768 @findex gnus-article-babel
7769 Translate the article from one language to another
7770 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
7776 @section @sc{mime} Commands
7777 @cindex MIME decoding
7779 @cindex viewing attachments
7781 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
7782 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @sc{mime} part''.
7788 @kindex K v (Summary)
7789 View the @sc{mime} part.
7792 @kindex K o (Summary)
7793 Save the @sc{mime} part.
7796 @kindex K c (Summary)
7797 Copy the @sc{mime} part.
7800 @kindex K e (Summary)
7801 View the @sc{mime} part externally.
7804 @kindex K i (Summary)
7805 View the @sc{mime} part internally.
7808 @kindex K | (Summary)
7809 Pipe the @sc{mime} part to an external command.
7812 The rest of these @sc{mime} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
7817 @kindex K b (Summary)
7818 Make all the @sc{mime} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
7819 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
7823 @kindex K m (Summary)
7824 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
7825 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
7826 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
7827 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
7828 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
7831 @kindex X m (Summary)
7832 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
7833 Save all parts matching a @sc{mime} type to a directory
7834 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
7835 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
7838 @kindex M-t (Summary)
7839 @findex gnus-summary-display-buttonized
7840 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
7841 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
7844 @kindex W M w (Summary)
7845 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
7846 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
7849 @kindex W M c (Summary)
7850 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
7851 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
7853 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
7854 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
7855 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
7856 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not include
7857 MIME headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic parameter to
7858 the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
7861 @kindex W M v (Summary)
7862 View all the @sc{mime} parts in the current article
7863 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
7870 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
7871 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
7872 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
7873 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
7876 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
7879 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
7883 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
7884 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
7885 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
7886 this list won't have @sc{mime} buttons inserted unless they aren't
7887 displayed. The default value is @code{(".*/.*")}.
7889 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
7890 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
7891 For each @sc{mime} part, this function will be called with the @sc{mime}
7892 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
7893 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
7894 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
7895 save all jpegs into some directory).
7897 Here's an example function the does the latter:
7900 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
7901 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
7903 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
7904 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
7905 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
7906 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
7907 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
7910 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
7911 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
7912 Alist of @sc{mime} multipart types and functions to handle them.
7921 People use different charsets, and we have @sc{mime} to let us know what
7922 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
7923 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @sc{mime}, and
7924 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
7925 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
7926 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
7927 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
7929 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
7930 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
7931 variable, which is an alist of regexps (to match group names) and
7932 default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
7934 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @sc{mime}-aware agents that
7935 aren't. These blitely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1} even
7936 if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
7937 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
7938 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be set
7939 on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
7940 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit)}, which is
7941 something some agents insist on having in there.
7943 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
7944 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
7945 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @sc{mime}
7946 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
7947 quoted-printable header encoding.
7949 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
7950 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
7951 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
7955 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
7958 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
7959 means encode all charsets),
7961 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
7962 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
7963 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
7970 @cindex coding system aliases
7971 @cindex preferred charset
7973 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
7975 If there are several @sc{mime} charsets that encode the same Emacs
7976 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
7979 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
7980 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
7983 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
7984 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @sc{mime} charset.
7986 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
7989 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
7992 This will almost do the right thing.
7994 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
7998 (codepage-setup 1251)
7999 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
8003 @node Article Commands
8004 @section Article Commands
8011 @kindex A P (Summary)
8012 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
8013 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
8014 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
8015 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will be
8016 run just before printing the buffer.
8021 @node Summary Sorting
8022 @section Summary Sorting
8023 @cindex summary sorting
8025 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
8026 can't really see why you'd want that.
8031 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
8032 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
8033 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
8036 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
8037 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
8038 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
8041 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
8042 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
8043 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
8046 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
8047 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
8048 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
8051 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
8052 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
8053 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
8056 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
8057 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
8058 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
8061 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
8062 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
8063 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
8066 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
8067 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
8068 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
8069 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
8070 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
8074 @node Finding the Parent
8075 @section Finding the Parent
8076 @cindex parent articles
8077 @cindex referring articles
8082 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
8083 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
8084 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
8085 if the current group is fetched by @sc{nntp}, the parent hasn't expired
8086 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
8087 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
8088 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
8089 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
8090 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
8092 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
8093 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
8094 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
8095 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
8096 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
8100 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
8101 @kindex A R (Summary)
8102 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
8103 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
8106 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
8107 @kindex A T (Summary)
8108 Display the full thread where the current article appears
8109 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
8110 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
8111 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
8112 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
8113 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
8114 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
8116 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
8117 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
8118 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
8119 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
8120 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
8121 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
8124 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
8125 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
8127 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
8128 You can also ask the @sc{nntp} server for an arbitrary article, no
8129 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
8130 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
8131 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
8132 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
8133 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
8136 The current select method will be used when fetching by
8137 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
8138 by giving this command a prefix.
8140 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
8141 If the group you are reading is located on a backend that does not
8142 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
8143 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @sc{nntp} method. It
8144 would, perhaps, be best if the @sc{nntp} server you consult is the one
8145 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
8148 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
8149 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
8150 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
8153 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
8154 then ask Deja if that fails:
8157 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
8159 (nnweb "refer" (nnweb-type dejanews))))
8162 Most of the mail backends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but do
8163 not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox} and
8164 @code{nnbabyl} are able to locate articles from any groups, while
8165 @code{nnml} and @code{nnfolder} are only able to locate articles that
8166 have been posted to the current group. (Anything else would be too time
8167 consuming.) @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
8170 @node Alternative Approaches
8171 @section Alternative Approaches
8173 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
8174 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
8177 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
8178 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
8183 @subsection Pick and Read
8184 @cindex pick and read
8186 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
8187 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
8188 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
8189 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
8191 @findex gnus-pick-mode
8192 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
8193 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
8194 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
8195 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
8196 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
8198 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
8203 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
8204 Pick the article or thread on the current line
8205 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
8206 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
8207 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
8208 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
8209 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
8210 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
8213 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
8214 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
8215 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
8216 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
8220 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
8221 Unpick the thread or article
8222 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
8223 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
8224 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
8225 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
8226 the thread or article at that line.
8230 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
8231 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
8232 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
8233 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
8234 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
8235 will still be visible when you are reading.
8239 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
8240 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
8241 which is mapped to the same function
8242 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
8244 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
8247 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
8250 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
8251 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
8253 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
8254 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
8255 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
8257 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
8258 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
8259 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
8260 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
8261 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
8262 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
8263 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
8267 @subsection Binary Groups
8268 @cindex binary groups
8270 @findex gnus-binary-mode
8271 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
8272 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
8273 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
8274 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
8275 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
8276 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
8279 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
8280 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
8281 command, when you have turned on this mode
8282 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
8284 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
8285 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
8289 @section Tree Display
8292 @vindex gnus-use-trees
8293 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
8294 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
8295 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
8298 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
8301 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
8302 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
8303 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
8305 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
8306 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
8307 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
8308 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
8309 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
8311 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
8312 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
8313 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
8314 default is @code{modeline}.
8316 @item gnus-tree-line-format
8317 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
8318 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
8319 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
8320 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
8321 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
8322 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
8328 The name of the poster.
8330 The @code{From} header.
8332 The number of the article.
8334 The opening bracket.
8336 The closing bracket.
8341 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
8343 Variables related to the display are:
8346 @item gnus-tree-brackets
8347 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
8348 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
8349 ``sparse'' articles. The format is @code{((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
8350 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close}) (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))}, and the
8351 default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
8353 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
8354 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
8355 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
8356 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
8360 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
8361 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
8362 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
8363 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
8364 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
8365 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
8366 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
8367 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
8368 other windows displayed next to it.
8370 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
8371 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
8372 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
8373 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
8374 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
8375 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
8376 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
8380 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
8383 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
8393 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
8397 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
8398 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
8400 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
8402 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
8407 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
8408 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
8409 following to your @file{.gnus.el} file:
8412 (setq gnus-use-trees t
8413 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
8414 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
8415 (gnus-add-configuration
8419 (summary 0.75 point)
8424 @xref{Windows Configuration}.
8427 @node Mail Group Commands
8428 @section Mail Group Commands
8429 @cindex mail group commands
8431 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
8432 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
8434 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
8435 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
8440 @kindex B e (Summary)
8441 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
8442 Expire all expirable articles in the group
8443 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}).
8446 @kindex B M-C-e (Summary)
8447 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
8448 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
8449 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
8450 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
8451 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
8454 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
8455 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
8456 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
8457 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
8458 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
8459 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
8462 @kindex B m (Summary)
8464 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
8465 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
8466 Move the article from one mail group to another
8467 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
8468 @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
8471 @kindex B c (Summary)
8473 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
8474 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
8475 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
8476 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
8477 @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
8480 @kindex B B (Summary)
8481 @cindex crosspost mail
8482 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
8483 Crosspost the current article to some other group
8484 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
8485 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
8486 be properly updated.
8489 @kindex B i (Summary)
8490 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
8491 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
8492 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
8493 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
8496 @kindex B r (Summary)
8497 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
8498 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
8499 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
8500 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
8501 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
8502 Marks will be preserved if @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
8503 (which is the default).
8507 @kindex B w (Summary)
8509 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
8510 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
8511 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
8512 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
8513 (@kbd{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
8514 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
8517 @kindex B q (Summary)
8518 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
8519 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
8520 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
8521 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
8524 @kindex B t (Summary)
8525 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
8526 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
8527 when repooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
8530 @kindex B p (Summary)
8531 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
8532 Some people have a tendency to send you "courtesy" copies when they
8533 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
8534 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
8535 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
8536 article from your news server (or rather, from
8537 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
8538 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
8539 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
8540 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
8541 just not have arrived yet.
8545 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
8546 @cindex moving articles
8547 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
8548 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
8549 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
8550 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
8551 suggestions you find reasonable.
8554 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
8555 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
8556 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
8557 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
8561 @node Various Summary Stuff
8562 @section Various Summary Stuff
8565 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
8566 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
8567 * Summary Generation Commands:: (Re)generating the summary buffer.
8568 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
8572 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
8573 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
8574 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
8576 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
8577 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
8578 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
8579 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
8580 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
8581 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
8584 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
8585 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
8586 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
8587 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
8588 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
8590 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
8591 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
8592 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
8595 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
8596 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
8597 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
8598 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
8599 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
8600 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
8601 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
8602 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
8603 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
8604 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
8606 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
8607 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
8608 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
8609 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
8610 list of articles to be selected.
8612 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
8613 the list in one particular group:
8616 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
8617 (if (string= group "some.group")
8618 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
8625 @node Summary Group Information
8626 @subsection Summary Group Information
8631 @kindex H f (Summary)
8632 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
8633 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
8634 Try to fetch the FAQ (list of frequently asked questions) for the
8635 current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the
8636 FAQ from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory
8637 on a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
8638 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
8639 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will probably
8640 be used for fetching the file.
8643 @kindex H d (Summary)
8644 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
8645 Give a brief description of the current group
8646 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
8647 rereading the description from the server.
8650 @kindex H h (Summary)
8651 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
8652 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
8653 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
8656 @kindex H i (Summary)
8657 @findex gnus-info-find-node
8658 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
8662 @node Searching for Articles
8663 @subsection Searching for Articles
8668 @kindex M-s (Summary)
8669 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
8670 Search through all subsequent articles for a regexp
8671 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
8674 @kindex M-r (Summary)
8675 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
8676 Search through all previous articles for a regexp
8677 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
8681 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
8682 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
8683 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
8684 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
8685 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
8686 search backward instead.
8688 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string #} will put the process mark on
8689 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
8692 @kindex M-& (Summary)
8693 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
8694 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
8695 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
8698 @node Summary Generation Commands
8699 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
8704 @kindex Y g (Summary)
8705 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
8706 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
8709 @kindex Y c (Summary)
8710 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
8711 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
8712 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
8717 @node Really Various Summary Commands
8718 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
8724 @kindex C-d (Summary)
8725 @kindex A D (Summary)
8726 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
8727 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
8728 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
8729 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
8730 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
8731 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
8732 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
8733 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
8737 @kindex M-C-d (Summary)
8738 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
8739 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
8740 several documents into one biiig group
8741 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
8742 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
8743 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
8744 command understands the process/prefix convention
8745 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
8748 @kindex C-t (Summary)
8749 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
8750 Toggle truncation of summary lines
8751 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
8752 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
8753 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
8757 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
8758 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
8759 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
8762 @kindex M-C-e (Summary)
8763 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
8764 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
8765 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
8768 @kindex M-C-a (Summary)
8769 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
8770 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
8771 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
8776 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
8777 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
8778 @cindex summary exit
8779 @cindex exiting groups
8781 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
8782 group and return you to the group buffer.
8788 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
8790 @findex gnus-summary-exit
8791 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
8792 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
8793 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
8794 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
8795 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
8796 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
8797 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
8798 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
8799 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
8800 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
8804 @kindex Z E (Summary)
8806 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
8807 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
8808 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
8812 @kindex Z c (Summary)
8814 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
8815 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
8816 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
8817 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
8820 @kindex Z C (Summary)
8821 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
8822 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
8823 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
8826 @kindex Z n (Summary)
8827 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
8828 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
8829 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
8832 @kindex Z R (Summary)
8833 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
8834 Exit this group, and then enter it again
8835 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
8836 all articles, both read and unread.
8840 @kindex Z G (Summary)
8841 @kindex M-g (Summary)
8842 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
8843 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
8844 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
8845 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
8846 articles, both read and unread.
8849 @kindex Z N (Summary)
8850 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
8851 Exit the group and go to the next group
8852 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
8855 @kindex Z P (Summary)
8856 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
8857 Exit the group and go to the previous group
8858 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
8861 @kindex Z s (Summary)
8862 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
8863 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
8864 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
8865 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
8866 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
8869 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
8870 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
8871 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
8872 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
8874 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
8875 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
8876 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
8877 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
8878 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
8879 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
8880 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
8881 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
8882 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
8883 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
8884 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
8885 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
8887 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
8889 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
8890 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
8891 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
8892 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
8893 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
8894 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
8895 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
8896 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
8897 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
8900 @node Crosspost Handling
8901 @section Crosspost Handling
8905 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
8906 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
8907 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
8908 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
8909 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
8910 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
8913 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
8914 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
8915 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
8916 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
8917 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
8919 @cindex cross-posting
8922 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
8923 correctly is if you use an @sc{nntp} server that supports @sc{xover}
8924 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
8925 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @sc{nov} lines. This is
8926 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
8927 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
8928 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
8929 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
8930 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
8931 the cross reference mechanism.
8933 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
8934 @cindex overview.fmt
8935 To check whether your @sc{nntp} server includes the @code{Xref} header
8936 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
8937 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
8938 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
8939 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
8940 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
8943 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
8944 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
8945 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
8950 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
8953 @node Duplicate Suppression
8954 @section Duplicate Suppression
8956 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
8957 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
8958 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
8959 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
8964 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
8965 is evil and not very common.
8968 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
8969 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
8972 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
8973 different @sc{nntp} servers.
8976 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
8979 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
8980 well, but these four are the most common situations.
8982 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
8983 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
8984 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
8985 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
8986 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
8987 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
8988 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
8991 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
8992 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
8993 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
8994 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
8995 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
8999 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
9000 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
9001 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
9003 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
9004 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
9005 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
9006 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
9007 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
9008 session are suppressed.
9010 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
9011 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
9012 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
9013 suppression list. The default is 10000.
9015 @item gnus-duplicate-file
9016 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
9017 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
9018 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
9021 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
9022 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
9023 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
9024 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
9025 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
9026 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
9027 to you to figure out, I think.
9030 @node The Article Buffer
9031 @chapter The Article Buffer
9032 @cindex article buffer
9034 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
9035 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
9036 tell Gnus otherwise.
9039 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
9040 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
9041 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
9042 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
9043 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
9047 @node Hiding Headers
9048 @section Hiding Headers
9049 @cindex hiding headers
9050 @cindex deleting headers
9052 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
9053 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
9055 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
9056 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
9057 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
9058 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
9059 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
9060 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
9061 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseum---and you'll probably want to get rid
9062 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
9063 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
9065 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
9069 @item gnus-visible-headers
9070 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
9071 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
9072 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
9073 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
9075 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
9076 the article and the subject, you'd say:
9079 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
9082 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
9085 @item gnus-ignored-headers
9086 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
9087 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
9088 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
9089 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
9090 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
9092 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
9093 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
9096 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
9099 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
9102 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
9103 variable will have no effect.
9107 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
9108 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
9109 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
9110 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
9111 the headers are to be displayed.
9113 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
9114 and then the subject, you might say something like:
9117 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
9120 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
9121 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
9123 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
9124 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
9125 You can hide further boring headers by setting
9126 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-header} to @code{head}. What this function
9127 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
9128 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead is
9129 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
9132 These conditions are:
9135 Remove all empty headers.
9137 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
9138 @code{Newsgroups} header.
9140 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same address as the
9143 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
9146 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
9149 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
9151 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
9154 To include the four three elements, you could say something like;
9157 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
9158 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
9161 This is also the default value for this variable.
9165 @section Using @sc{mime}
9168 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
9169 while people stand around yawning.
9171 @sc{mime}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
9172 while all newsreaders die of fear.
9174 @sc{mime} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
9175 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
9176 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
9178 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
9179 @findex gnus-display-mime
9180 Gnus pushes @sc{mime} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
9181 to display the @sc{mime} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
9182 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
9183 display, save and manipulate the @sc{mime} objects.
9185 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
9189 @findex gnus-article-press-button
9191 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
9192 Toggle displaying of the @sc{mime} object
9193 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}).
9195 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
9196 @item M-RET (Article)
9198 Prompt for a method, and then view the @sc{mime} object using this
9199 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
9201 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
9203 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @sc{mime} object
9204 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
9206 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
9208 Copy the @sc{mime} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
9209 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}).
9211 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
9213 View the @sc{mime} object as if it were a different @sc{mime} media type
9214 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
9216 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
9218 Output the @sc{mime} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
9220 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
9222 Insert the contents of the @sc{mime} object into the buffer
9223 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
9224 the raw contens without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
9225 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
9226 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @pxref{Paging the
9229 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
9231 Interactively run an action on the @sc{mime} object
9232 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
9236 Gnus will display some @sc{mime} objects automatically. The way Gnus
9237 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs MIME
9240 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
9241 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
9242 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @sc{mime} has
9243 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
9244 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
9245 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
9246 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
9247 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
9248 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
9250 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
9252 Also see @pxref{MIME Commands}.
9255 @node Customizing Articles
9256 @section Customizing Articles
9257 @cindex article customization
9259 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
9260 exist. You can call these functions interactively, or you can have them
9261 called automatically when you select the articles.
9263 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
9264 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
9265 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
9266 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
9268 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
9269 for sensible values.
9273 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
9276 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
9279 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
9282 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
9285 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
9289 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
9290 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
9291 regexps in the list.
9294 A list where the first element is not a string:
9296 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
9297 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
9298 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
9302 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
9307 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
9308 to the fact that some messages are @sc{mime} multipart articles that may
9309 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
9310 considered to contain just a single part.
9312 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
9313 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
9314 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
9315 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
9316 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
9317 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
9318 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
9320 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
9321 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
9322 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
9323 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
9326 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last)
9327 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
9328 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
9329 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
9330 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
9331 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
9332 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
9333 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
9334 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
9335 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
9336 @item gnus-treat-strip-pgp (t, last, integer)
9337 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
9338 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
9339 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
9340 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
9341 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
9342 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
9343 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
9344 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
9345 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
9346 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
9347 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
9348 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
9349 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
9350 @item gnus-treat-display-xface (head)
9351 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
9352 @item gnus-treat-display-picons (head)
9353 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
9354 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
9355 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
9356 @item gnus-treat-translate
9359 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
9360 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
9361 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
9362 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
9363 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
9367 @node Article Keymap
9368 @section Article Keymap
9370 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
9371 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
9372 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
9373 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
9376 A few additional keystrokes are available:
9381 @kindex SPACE (Article)
9382 @findex gnus-article-next-page
9383 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
9386 @kindex DEL (Article)
9387 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
9388 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
9391 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
9392 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
9393 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
9394 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
9395 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
9398 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
9399 @findex gnus-article-mail
9400 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
9401 given a prefix, include the mail.
9405 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
9406 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
9407 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
9411 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
9412 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
9413 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
9416 @kindex TAB (Article)
9417 @findex gnus-article-next-button
9418 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
9419 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
9422 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
9423 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
9424 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
9430 @section Misc Article
9434 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
9435 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
9436 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
9437 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
9440 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
9441 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
9443 Hook used to decode @sc{mime} articles. The default value is
9444 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
9446 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
9447 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
9448 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
9449 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
9450 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
9451 the contents of the article buffer.
9453 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
9454 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
9455 Hook called in article mode buffers.
9457 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
9458 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
9459 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
9460 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
9462 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
9463 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
9464 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
9465 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
9466 accepts the same format specifications as that variable, with two
9471 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
9472 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
9475 The number of @sc{mime} parts in the article.
9478 @vindex gnus-break-pages
9480 @item gnus-break-pages
9481 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
9482 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
9483 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
9484 paging will not be done.
9486 @item gnus-page-delimiter
9487 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
9488 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
9493 @node Composing Messages
9494 @chapter Composing Messages
9495 @cindex composing messages
9498 @cindex sending mail
9503 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
9504 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
9505 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
9506 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Top, message, The
9507 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
9508 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
9511 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
9512 * Post:: Posting and following up.
9513 * Posting Server:: What server should you post via?
9514 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
9515 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
9516 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
9517 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
9518 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
9521 Also see @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
9522 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
9528 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
9531 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
9532 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
9533 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
9534 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched.
9536 @item gnus-add-to-list
9537 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
9538 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
9539 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
9541 @item message-send-mail-partially-limit
9542 @vindex message-send-mail-partially-limit
9543 The limitation of messages sent as message/partial.
9544 The lower bound of message size in characters, beyond which the message
9545 should be sent in several parts. If it is nil, the size is unlimited.
9553 Variables for composing news articles:
9556 @item gnus-sent-message-ids-file
9557 @vindex gnus-sent-message-ids-file
9558 Gnus will keep a @code{Message-ID} history file of all the mails it has
9559 sent. If it discovers that it has already sent a mail, it will ask the
9560 user whether to re-send the mail. (This is primarily useful when
9561 dealing with @sc{soup} packets and the like where one is apt to send the
9562 same packet multiple times.) This variable says what the name of this
9563 history file is. It is @file{~/News/Sent-Message-IDs} by default. Set
9564 this variable to @code{nil} if you don't want Gnus to keep a history
9567 @item gnus-sent-message-ids-length
9568 @vindex gnus-sent-message-ids-length
9569 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the history
9570 file. It is 1000 by default.
9575 @node Posting Server
9576 @section Posting Server
9578 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
9579 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
9581 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
9583 @vindex gnus-post-method
9585 It can be quite complicated. Normally, Gnus will use the same native
9586 server. However. If your native server doesn't allow posting, just
9587 reading, you probably want to use some other server to post your
9588 (extremely intelligent and fabulously interesting) articles. You can
9589 then set the @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
9592 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
9595 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
9596 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
9597 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
9598 the ``current'' server for posting.
9600 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
9601 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
9603 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
9604 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
9607 Finally, if you want to always post using the same select method as
9608 you're reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
9609 groups from different private servers), you can set this variable to
9614 @section Mail and Post
9616 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
9620 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
9621 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
9622 @cindex mailing lists
9624 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
9625 gatewayed to the @sc{nntp} server, you can read those groups without
9626 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
9627 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
9628 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
9629 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
9630 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
9631 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
9632 still a pain, though.
9636 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
9637 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
9638 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
9641 @findex ispell-message
9643 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
9646 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
9647 you're in, you could say something like the following:
9650 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
9653 ((string-match "^de\\." gnus-newsgroup-name)
9654 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
9656 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
9659 Modify to suit your needs.
9662 @node Archived Messages
9663 @section Archived Messages
9664 @cindex archived messages
9665 @cindex sent messages
9667 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
9668 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
9669 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
9670 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
9673 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
9674 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
9675 use to store sent messages. The default is:
9679 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
9680 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
9681 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
9682 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
9685 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
9686 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likeable select method
9687 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
9688 directory chosen, you could say something like:
9691 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
9692 '(nnfolder "archive"
9693 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
9694 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
9695 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
9698 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
9700 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
9701 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
9702 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
9704 This variable can be used to do the following:
9708 Messages will be saved in that group.
9710 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
9711 message will not be stored in the select method given by
9712 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
9713 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
9714 has the default value shown above. Then setting
9715 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
9716 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
9717 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
9719 @item a list of strings
9720 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
9721 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
9722 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
9724 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
9729 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
9731 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
9734 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
9736 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
9739 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
9741 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9742 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
9743 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
9744 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
9749 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9750 '((if (message-news-p)
9755 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
9756 messages in one file per month:
9759 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9760 '((if (message-news-p)
9762 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
9765 (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
9766 use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
9768 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
9769 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
9770 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
9771 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
9772 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
9773 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
9774 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
9775 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
9776 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
9777 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
9779 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
9780 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
9781 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
9782 this will disable archiving.
9785 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
9786 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
9787 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
9788 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
9789 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
9792 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
9793 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
9794 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
9797 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
9798 but the latter is the preferred method.
9802 @node Posting Styles
9803 @section Posting Styles
9804 @cindex posting styles
9807 All them variables, they make my head swim.
9809 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
9810 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
9811 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
9814 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
9815 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
9816 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
9817 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
9818 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
9823 (signature "Peace and happiness")
9824 (organization "What me?"))
9826 (signature "Death to everybody"))
9827 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
9828 (organization "Emacs is it")))
9831 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
9832 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
9833 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
9834 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
9835 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
9836 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
9837 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
9838 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
9840 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
9841 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
9842 If it is the symbol @code{header}, then Gnus will look for header that
9843 match the next element in the match, and compare that to the last header
9844 in the match. If it's a function symbol, that function will be called
9845 with no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
9846 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
9847 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is said
9850 Each style may contain a arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
9851 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} . @var{value})} pair. The
9852 attribute name can be one of @code{signature}, @code{signature-file},
9853 @code{organization}, @code{address}, @code{name} or @code{body}. The
9854 attribute name can also be a string. In that case, this will be used as
9855 a header name, and the value will be inserted in the headers of the
9856 article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header name will be removed.
9857 If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form is evaluated, and the
9858 result is thrown away.
9860 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
9861 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
9862 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
9863 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
9864 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
9865 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable.
9867 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
9868 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
9869 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
9871 @findex message-mail-p
9872 @findex message-news-p
9874 So here's a new example:
9877 (setq gnus-posting-styles
9879 (signature-file "~/.signature")
9881 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
9882 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
9884 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
9885 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly")
9886 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
9888 (signature my-news-signature))
9889 (header "From\\|To" "larsi.*org"
9890 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
9891 ((posting-from-work-p)
9892 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
9893 (address "user@@bar.foo")
9894 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
9895 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
9897 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
9905 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
9906 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
9907 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
9908 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
9909 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
9911 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
9912 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
9913 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
9914 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
9915 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
9919 @vindex nndraft-directory
9920 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
9921 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
9922 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
9923 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
9924 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
9925 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
9927 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
9928 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
9931 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
9932 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
9933 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
9934 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
9935 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
9936 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
9937 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
9938 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
9939 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
9940 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
9941 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
9942 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
9943 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
9944 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
9946 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
9947 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
9948 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
9950 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
9952 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
9953 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
9954 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
9956 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
9959 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
9960 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
9961 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
9962 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
9963 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
9964 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
9965 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
9968 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
9969 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
9970 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
9973 @node Rejected Articles
9974 @section Rejected Articles
9975 @cindex rejected articles
9977 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
9978 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
9979 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
9980 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
9982 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
9983 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
9984 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
9985 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
9986 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
9988 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
9989 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
9990 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
9993 @node Select Methods
9994 @chapter Select Methods
9995 @cindex foreign groups
9996 @cindex select methods
9998 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
9999 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
10000 @sc{nntp} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
10001 personal mail group.
10003 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
10004 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
10005 list where the first element says what backend to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
10006 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
10007 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
10008 value may have special meaning for the backend in question.
10010 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
10011 we do just that (@pxref{The Server Buffer}).
10013 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the backend will recognize the
10016 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @sc{nntp} server
10017 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
10018 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
10019 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
10020 backend just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
10022 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
10025 * The Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
10026 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
10027 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
10028 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
10029 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
10030 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
10031 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
10035 @node The Server Buffer
10036 @section The Server Buffer
10038 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
10039 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
10040 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
10041 one backend or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
10042 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
10043 backend represents a virtual server.
10045 For instance, the @code{nntp} backend may be used to connect to several
10046 different actual @sc{nntp} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
10047 on the same actual @sc{nntp} server. You tell Gnus which backend to
10048 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
10050 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
10051 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
10052 @sc{nntp} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
10053 hangs if queried for @sc{nov} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
10054 Anyways, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
10055 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
10056 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
10058 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
10059 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
10062 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
10063 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
10064 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
10065 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
10066 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
10067 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
10068 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
10071 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
10072 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
10075 @node Server Buffer Format
10076 @subsection Server Buffer Format
10077 @cindex server buffer format
10079 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
10080 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
10081 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
10082 variable, with some simple extensions:
10087 How the news is fetched---the backend name.
10090 The name of this server.
10093 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
10096 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
10099 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
10100 The mode line can also be customized by using the
10101 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
10102 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
10112 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
10115 @node Server Commands
10116 @subsection Server Commands
10117 @cindex server commands
10123 @findex gnus-server-add-server
10124 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
10128 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
10129 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
10132 @kindex SPACE (Server)
10133 @findex gnus-server-read-server
10134 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
10138 @findex gnus-server-exit
10139 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
10143 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
10144 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
10148 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
10149 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
10153 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
10154 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
10158 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
10159 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
10163 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
10164 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
10165 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
10170 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
10171 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
10172 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
10173 a mail backend that has gotten out of synch.
10178 @node Example Methods
10179 @subsection Example Methods
10181 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
10184 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
10187 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
10193 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
10194 backend, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
10197 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
10198 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
10200 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
10201 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
10205 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
10208 You should read the documentation to each backend to find out what
10209 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
10211 @code{nnmh} is a mail backend that reads a spool-like structure. Say
10212 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
10213 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
10217 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
10220 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
10223 Here's the method for a public spool:
10227 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
10228 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
10234 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @sc{nntp}
10235 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
10236 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @sc{nntp} server.
10237 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
10238 should probably look something like this:
10242 (nntp-address "the.firewall.machine")
10243 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
10244 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
10245 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
10246 ("telnet" "the.real.nntp.host" "nntp")))
10249 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
10250 compressed connection over the modem line, you could create a virtual
10251 server that would look something like this:
10255 (nntp-address "copper.uio.no")
10256 (nntp-rlogin-program "ssh")
10257 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
10258 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
10259 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
10260 ("telnet" "news.uio.no" "nntp")))
10263 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
10264 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
10265 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
10266 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
10269 @node Creating a Virtual Server
10270 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
10272 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
10273 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
10275 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
10276 would probably be best to use @code{nnspool} to read the cache. You
10277 could also use @code{nnml} or @code{nnmh}, though.
10279 Type @kbd{a nnspool RET cache RET}.
10281 You should now have a brand new @code{nnspool} virtual server called
10282 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
10283 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
10284 will contain the following:
10294 (nnspool-spool-directory "~/News/cache/")
10295 (nnspool-nov-directory "~/News/cache/")
10296 (nnspool-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
10299 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
10300 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
10301 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
10304 @node Server Variables
10305 @subsection Server Variables
10307 One sticky point when defining variables (both on backends and in Emacs
10308 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
10309 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
10310 change the "base" variable after the variables have been loaded, you
10311 won't change the "derived" variables.
10313 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
10314 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
10315 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
10316 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
10317 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
10318 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
10319 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
10320 variables for each backend, see each backend's section later in this
10321 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
10325 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
10326 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
10327 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
10331 @node Servers and Methods
10332 @subsection Servers and Methods
10334 Wherever you would normally use a select method
10335 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
10336 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
10337 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
10341 @node Unavailable Servers
10342 @subsection Unavailable Servers
10344 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
10345 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
10346 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
10347 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
10348 actually the case or not.
10350 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
10351 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
10352 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
10353 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
10354 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
10355 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
10356 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
10357 it will regard that server as ``down''.
10359 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
10360 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
10362 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{The Server Buffer}) and poke it
10363 with the following commands:
10369 @findex gnus-server-open-server
10370 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
10371 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
10375 @findex gnus-server-close-server
10376 Close the connection (if any) to the server
10377 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
10381 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
10382 Mark the current server as unreachable
10383 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
10386 @kindex M-o (Server)
10387 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
10388 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
10389 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
10392 @kindex M-c (Server)
10393 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
10394 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
10395 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
10399 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
10400 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
10401 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
10407 @section Getting News
10408 @cindex reading news
10409 @cindex news backends
10411 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
10412 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @sc{nntp} server,
10413 or it can read from a local spool.
10416 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
10417 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
10422 @subsection @sc{nntp}
10425 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @sc{nntp} server is rather easy.
10426 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @sc{nntp}
10427 server as the, uhm, address.
10429 If the @sc{nntp} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
10430 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
10431 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
10432 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
10434 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
10435 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
10436 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
10438 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
10443 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
10444 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
10445 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
10447 @cindex authentification
10448 @cindex nntp authentification
10449 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
10450 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
10451 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
10452 commands to the @sc{nntp} server after it has been contacted. By
10453 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
10454 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
10455 present in this hook.
10457 @item nntp-authinfo-function
10458 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
10459 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
10460 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
10461 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @sc{nntp}
10462 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
10463 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
10464 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
10465 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
10466 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
10467 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
10468 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
10472 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
10475 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs. The
10476 valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
10477 @samp{default}, @samp{port} and @samp{force}. (The latter is not a
10478 valid @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} token, which is almost the only way the
10479 @file{.authinfo} file format deviates from the @file{.netrc} file
10484 Here's an example file:
10487 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
10488 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
10491 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
10492 have to be first, for instance.
10494 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
10495 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
10496 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
10497 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
10498 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
10499 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
10500 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
10502 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
10503 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
10509 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
10510 previously mentioned.
10512 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
10514 @item nntp-server-action-alist
10515 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
10516 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
10517 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
10518 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
10521 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
10522 '(("innd" (ding))))
10525 You probably don't want to do that, though.
10527 The default value is
10530 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
10531 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
10534 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
10535 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
10537 @item nntp-maximum-request
10538 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
10539 If the @sc{nntp} server doesn't support @sc{nov} headers, this backend
10540 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
10541 speed things up, the backend sends lots of these commands without
10542 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
10543 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
10544 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
10546 @item nntp-connection-timeout
10547 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
10548 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
10549 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @sc{nntp} servers not
10550 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
10551 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
10552 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
10553 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} backend should wait for a
10554 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
10555 no timeouts are done.
10557 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
10558 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
10559 @c @cindex PPP connections
10560 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
10561 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
10562 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
10563 @c changes after connecting to the @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will simply sit
10564 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
10565 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
10566 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
10567 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
10568 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
10569 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
10571 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
10572 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
10573 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
10574 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
10575 @c described above.
10577 @item nntp-server-hook
10578 @vindex nntp-server-hook
10579 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @sc{nntp}
10582 @findex nntp-open-rlogin
10583 @findex nntp-open-telnet
10584 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
10585 @item nntp-open-connection-function
10586 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
10587 This function is used to connect to the remote system. Four pre-made
10588 functions are supplied:
10591 @item nntp-open-network-stream
10592 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
10595 @item nntp-open-rlogin
10596 Does an @samp{rlogin} on the
10597 remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet} to the @sc{nntp} server
10600 @code{nntp-open-rlogin}-related variables:
10604 @item nntp-rlogin-program
10605 @vindex nntp-rlogin-program
10606 Program used to log in on remote machines. The default is @samp{rsh},
10607 but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
10609 @item nntp-rlogin-parameters
10610 @vindex nntp-rlogin-parameters
10611 This list will be used as the parameter list given to @code{rsh}.
10613 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
10614 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
10615 User name on the remote system.
10619 @item nntp-open-telnet
10620 Does a @samp{telnet} to the remote system and then another @samp{telnet}
10621 to get to the @sc{nntp} server.
10623 @code{nntp-open-telnet}-related variables:
10626 @item nntp-telnet-command
10627 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
10628 Command used to start @code{telnet}.
10630 @item nntp-telnet-switches
10631 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
10632 List of strings to be used as the switches to the @code{telnet} command.
10634 @item nntp-telnet-user-name
10635 @vindex nntp-telnet-user-name
10636 User name for log in on the remote system.
10638 @item nntp-telnet-passwd
10639 @vindex nntp-telnet-passwd
10640 Password to use when logging in.
10642 @item nntp-telnet-parameters
10643 @vindex nntp-telnet-parameters
10644 A list of strings executed as a command after logging in
10647 @item nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
10648 @vindex nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
10649 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the remote machine. The default is
10650 @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
10652 @item nntp-open-telnet-envuser
10653 @vindex nntp-open-telnet-envuser
10654 If non-@code{nil}, the @code{telnet} session (client and server both)
10655 will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for login name.
10656 This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
10660 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
10661 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
10662 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use this
10663 you must have SSLay installed
10664 (@file{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL}, and you also need
10665 @file{ssl.el} (from the W3 distributeion, for instance). You then
10666 define a server as follows:
10669 ;; Type `C-c C-c' after you've finished editing.
10671 ;; "snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our /etc/services
10673 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
10674 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
10675 (nntp-port-number "snews")
10676 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
10681 @item nntp-end-of-line
10682 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
10683 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @sc{nntp}
10684 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
10685 using @code{rlogin} to talk to the server.
10687 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
10688 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
10689 User name on the remote system when using the @code{rlogin} connect
10693 @vindex nntp-address
10694 The address of the remote system running the @sc{nntp} server.
10696 @item nntp-port-number
10697 @vindex nntp-port-number
10698 Port number to connect to when using the @code{nntp-open-network-stream}
10701 @item nntp-buggy-select
10702 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
10703 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
10705 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
10706 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
10707 If the @sc{nntp} server does not support @sc{nov}, you could set this
10708 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @sc{nov}
10711 @item nntp-xover-commands
10712 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
10715 List of strings used as commands to fetch @sc{nov} lines from a
10716 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
10720 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
10721 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @sc{nov} lines to
10722 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
10723 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
10724 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @sc{nov}
10725 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
10726 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
10727 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
10728 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
10729 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
10730 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
10732 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
10733 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
10734 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @sc{nntp} server.
10736 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
10737 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
10738 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
10739 server closes connection.
10741 @item nntp-record-commands
10742 @vindex nntp-record-commands
10743 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
10744 @sc{nntp} server (along with a timestep) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
10745 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@sc{nntp} connection
10746 that doesn't seem to work.
10752 @subsection News Spool
10756 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
10757 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
10758 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
10761 Anyways, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
10762 anything else) as the address.
10764 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
10765 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
10766 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
10767 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
10771 @item nnspool-inews-program
10772 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
10773 Program used to post an article.
10775 @item nnspool-inews-switches
10776 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
10777 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
10779 @item nnspool-spool-directory
10780 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
10781 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
10782 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
10784 @item nnspool-nov-directory
10785 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
10786 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @sc{nov} files. This is normally
10787 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
10789 @item nnspool-lib-dir
10790 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
10791 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
10793 @item nnspool-active-file
10794 @vindex nnspool-active-file
10795 The path to the active file.
10797 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
10798 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
10799 The path to the group descriptions file.
10801 @item nnspool-history-file
10802 @vindex nnspool-history-file
10803 The path to the news history file.
10805 @item nnspool-active-times-file
10806 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
10807 The path to the active date file.
10809 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
10810 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
10811 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @sc{nov} files
10814 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
10815 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
10817 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
10818 relevant portion from the overview file. If nil, @code{nnspool} will
10819 load the entire file into a buffer and process it there.
10825 @section Getting Mail
10826 @cindex reading mail
10829 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
10833 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
10834 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
10835 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
10836 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
10837 * Mail Backend Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
10838 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
10839 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
10840 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
10841 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
10842 * Washing Mail:: Removing gruft from the mail you get.
10843 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
10844 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail backends for reading other files.
10845 * Choosing a Mail Backend:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
10849 @node Mail in a Newsreader
10850 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
10852 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
10853 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
10854 of a culture shock.
10856 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
10857 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
10859 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
10860 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
10861 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
10862 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
10864 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
10866 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
10867 deleted? How awful!
10869 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
10870 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
10871 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
10872 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @pxref{Expiring
10875 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
10876 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
10877 they want to treat a message.
10879 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
10880 via SMTP, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
10881 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
10882 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
10883 archived somewhere else.
10885 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
10886 These are transported via @sc{nntp}, and are therefore news. But we may need
10887 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
10888 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
10889 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
10891 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
10892 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
10893 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
10895 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
10896 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
10899 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
10900 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
10901 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
10902 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
10903 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
10905 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
10906 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
10907 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
10908 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
10909 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
10910 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
10914 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
10915 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
10917 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
10918 mail backend of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
10919 and things will happen automatically.
10921 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a "one file per
10922 mail" backend), you could put the following in your @file{.gnus} file:
10925 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
10926 '((nnml "private")))
10929 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this backend will be queried for new
10930 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
10931 directory, which is @code{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
10932 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
10933 like any other group.
10935 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
10938 (setq nnmail-split-methods
10939 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
10940 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
10944 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
10945 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
10946 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
10949 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
10950 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
10951 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Backend} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
10954 @node Splitting Mail
10955 @subsection Splitting Mail
10956 @cindex splitting mail
10957 @cindex mail splitting
10959 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
10960 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
10961 to be split into groups.
10964 (setq nnmail-split-methods
10965 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
10966 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
10967 ("mail.other" "")))
10970 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
10971 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
10972 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
10973 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
10974 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
10975 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
10976 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
10979 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
10982 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
10983 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
10984 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
10985 mail belongs in that group.
10987 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
10988 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{} so that it matches any mails
10989 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
10990 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first
10991 rule to make a match will "win", unless you have crossposting enabled.
10992 In that case, all matching rules will "win".)
10994 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
10995 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
10996 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
10997 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
10998 thinks should carry this mail message.
11000 Note that the mail backends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
11001 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
11002 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
11003 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
11005 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
11006 The mail backends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
11007 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
11008 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
11009 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{}) group.
11011 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
11014 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
11015 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
11016 links. If that's the case for you, set
11017 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
11018 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
11020 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
11021 @kindex nnmail-split-history
11022 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
11023 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
11024 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
11025 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
11028 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
11029 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
11030 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
11031 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
11032 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
11033 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
11034 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
11035 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
11036 month's rent money.
11040 @subsection Mail Sources
11042 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from a
11043 POP mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a maildir, for
11047 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
11048 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
11049 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
11053 @node Mail Source Specifiers
11054 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
11056 @cindex mail server
11059 @cindex mail source
11061 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
11062 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
11067 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
11070 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
11071 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
11072 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
11075 The following mail source types are available:
11079 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
11085 The path of the file. Defaults to the value of the @code{MAIL}
11086 environment variable or @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}.
11089 An example file mail source:
11092 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
11095 Or using the default path:
11101 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best to
11102 use POP or @sc{imap} or the like to fetch the mail. You can not use ange-ftp
11103 file names here---it has no way to lock the mail spool while moving the
11106 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
11110 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
11113 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
11117 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
11120 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
11122 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
11125 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
11129 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used when
11130 you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files. Setting
11131 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-nil force Gnus to
11132 scan the mail source only once.
11138 The path of the directory where the files are. There is no default
11142 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
11146 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
11147 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
11148 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
11149 predicate are considered.
11153 Script run before/after fetching mail.
11157 An example directory mail source:
11160 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
11165 Get mail from a POP server.
11171 The name of the POP server. The default is taken from the
11172 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
11175 The port number of the POP server. This can be a number (eg,
11176 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
11177 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
11178 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}.
11181 The user name to give to the POP server. The default is the login
11185 The password to give to the POP server. If not specified, the user is
11189 The program to use to fetch mail from the POP server. This is should be
11190 a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
11193 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
11196 The valid format specifier characters are:
11200 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
11201 included in this string.
11204 The name of the server.
11207 The port number of the server.
11210 The user name to use.
11213 The password to use.
11216 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
11217 corresponding keywords.
11220 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
11221 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
11224 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
11225 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
11228 The function to use to fetch mail from the POP server. The function is
11229 called with one parameter---the name of the file where the mail should
11232 @item :authentication
11233 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
11234 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
11239 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
11240 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
11242 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default POP server, using the
11243 default user name, and default fetcher:
11249 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
11252 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
11253 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
11256 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
11259 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
11263 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
11264 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
11265 contains exactly one mail.
11271 The path of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
11272 taken from the @code{MAILDIR} environment variable or
11275 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
11276 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
11278 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
11279 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
11280 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
11283 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
11284 from locking problems).
11288 Two example maildir mail sources:
11291 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/" :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
11295 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/" :subdirs ("new"))
11299 Get mail from a @sc{imap} server. If you don't want to use @sc{imap} as
11300 intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie with nnimap), for some
11301 reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar to a POP server and
11302 fetches articles from a given @sc{imap} mailbox.
11308 The name of the @sc{imap} server. The default is taken from the
11309 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
11312 The port number of the @sc{imap} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
11313 @samp{993} for SSL connections.
11316 The user name to give to the @sc{imap} server. The default is the login
11320 The password to give to the @sc{imap} server. If not specified, the user is
11324 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
11325 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
11326 @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{ssl} or the default @samp{network}.
11328 @item :authentication
11329 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is one
11330 of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now, this
11331 means @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default
11335 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
11336 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
11339 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
11340 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
11341 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @sc{imap} client and mark some
11342 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{nil}.
11343 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
11344 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 §6.4.4.
11347 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
11348 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
11349 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
11350 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 §2.3.2.
11353 If non-nil, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the mailbox
11354 after finishing the fetch.
11358 An example @sc{imap} mail source:
11361 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com" :stream kerberos4 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
11365 Get mail from a webmail server, such as www.hotmail.com,
11366 webmail.netscape.com, www.netaddress.com, www.my-deja.com.
11368 NOTE: Now mail.yahoo.com provides POP3 service, so @sc{pop} mail source
11371 NOTE: Webmail largely depends cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
11372 required for url "4.0pre.46".
11374 WARNING: Mails may lost. NO WARRANTY.
11380 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
11381 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
11384 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
11388 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
11392 If non-nil, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to trash
11393 folder after finishing the fetch.
11397 An example webmail source:
11400 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail :user "user-name" :password "secret")
11405 @item Common Keywords
11406 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
11412 If non-nil, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you use
11413 directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this example:
11417 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
11422 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
11423 useful when you use local mail and news.
11428 @subsubheading Function Interface
11430 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
11431 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
11432 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
11433 consider the following mail-source setting:
11436 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
11437 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
11440 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
11441 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
11442 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
11443 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
11444 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
11446 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
11449 @node Mail Source Customization
11450 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
11452 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
11453 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
11457 @item mail-source-crash-box
11458 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
11459 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is
11460 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
11462 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
11463 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
11464 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them.
11466 @item mail-source-directory
11467 @vindex mail-source-directory
11468 Directory where files (if any) will be stored. The default is
11469 @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for is to say
11470 where the incoming files will be stored if the previous variable is
11473 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
11474 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
11475 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
11476 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
11477 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
11478 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
11480 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
11481 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
11482 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
11487 @node Fetching Mail
11488 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
11490 @vindex mail-sources
11491 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
11492 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
11493 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
11494 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
11496 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
11497 @code{nil}, the mail backends will never attempt to fetch mail by
11500 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a POP
11501 mail server, you'd say something like:
11506 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11507 :password "secret")))
11510 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
11514 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
11515 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11518 :password "secret")))
11522 When you use a mail backend, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
11523 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
11524 mail if you're not using a mail backend---you have to do a lot of magic
11525 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
11526 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
11527 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
11531 @node Mail Backend Variables
11532 @subsection Mail Backend Variables
11534 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
11538 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
11539 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
11540 The mail backends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
11541 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
11543 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
11544 @item nnmail-split-hook
11545 @findex article-decode-encoded-words
11546 @findex RFC 1522 decoding
11547 @findex RFC 2047 decoding
11548 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
11549 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
11550 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
11551 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
11552 in the buffer will show up in any files.
11553 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
11556 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11557 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
11558 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11559 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
11560 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
11561 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
11562 starting to handle the new mail) and
11563 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
11564 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
11565 default file modes the new mail files get:
11568 (add-hook 'gnus-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11569 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
11571 (add-hook 'gnus-post-get-new-mail-hook
11572 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
11575 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
11576 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
11577 If non-@code{nil}, the mail backends will use long file and directory
11578 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
11579 (assuming use of @code{nnml} backend) or files (assuming use of
11580 @code{nnfolder} backend) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
11581 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
11583 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
11584 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
11585 @findex delete-file
11586 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
11588 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11589 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11590 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
11591 the backend (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
11592 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
11597 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
11598 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
11599 @cindex mail splitting
11600 @cindex fancy mail splitting
11602 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
11603 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
11604 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
11605 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
11606 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
11607 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
11609 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
11612 ;; Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of
11613 ;; the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group
11614 ;; from real errors.
11615 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
11617 ;; Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant
11618 ;; groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the
11619 ;; (ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.
11620 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
11621 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
11622 ;; Other mailing lists...
11623 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
11624 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
11625 ;; Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent
11626 ;; cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to
11627 ;; the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the
11628 ;; message was really cross-posted.
11629 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
11630 (any "mypackage@@somewhere\" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
11632 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
11633 ;; Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.
11637 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a (possibly)
11638 recursive structure where each split may contain other splits. Here are
11639 the five possible split syntaxes:
11644 @samp{group}: If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group
11645 name. Normal regexp match expansion will be done. See below for
11649 @code{(@var{field} @var{value} @code{[-} @var{restrict}
11650 @code{[@dots{}]}@code{]} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, the
11651 first element of which is a string, then store the message as
11652 specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field} (a regexp) contains
11653 @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp)
11654 matches some string after @var{field} and before the end of the
11655 matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If none of the
11656 @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
11659 @code{(| @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11660 element is @code{|} (vertical bar), then process each @var{split} until
11661 one of them matches. A @var{split} is said to match if it will cause
11662 the mail message to be stored in one or more groups.
11665 @code{(& @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11666 element is @code{&}, then process all @var{split}s in the list.
11669 @code{junk}: If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save
11670 this message. Use with extreme caution.
11673 @code{(: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})}: If the split is
11674 a list, and the first element is @code{:}, then the second element will
11675 be called as a function with @var{args} given as arguments. The
11676 function should return a @var{split}.
11678 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
11679 body of the messages:
11682 (defun split-on-body ()
11684 (set-buffer " *nnmail incoming*")
11685 (goto-char (point-min))
11686 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
11691 @code{(! @var{func} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11692 element is @code{!}, then SPLIT will be processed, and FUNC will be
11693 called as a function with the result of SPLIT as argument. FUNC should
11697 @code{nil}: If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
11701 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
11702 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
11703 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
11704 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
11705 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
11707 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
11708 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be lisp symbols, in that case they
11709 are expanded as specified by the variable
11710 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells, where
11711 the @code{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @code{cdr} contains the associated
11714 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
11715 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
11716 when all this splitting is performed.
11718 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
11719 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
11720 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
11723 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
11726 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
11727 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
11729 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
11730 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
11731 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
11732 groupings 1 through 9.
11734 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
11735 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
11736 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
11737 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
11738 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
11739 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
11740 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
11741 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
11742 it once per thread.
11744 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to a
11745 non-nil value. And then you can include
11746 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} using the colon feature, like so:
11748 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
11749 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
11750 ;; other splits go here
11754 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
11755 non-nil, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees in the
11756 file specified by the variable @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file},
11757 together with the group it is in (the group is omitted for non-mail
11758 messages). When mail splitting is invoked, the function
11759 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks at the References (and
11760 In-Reply-To) header of each message to split and searches the file
11761 specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file} for the message ids.
11762 When it has found a parent, it returns the corresponding group name. It
11763 is recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
11764 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
11765 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
11766 300 kBytes in size.)
11769 @node Group Mail Splitting
11770 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
11771 @cindex mail splitting
11772 @cindex group mail splitting
11774 @findex gnus-group-split
11775 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
11776 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
11777 You just have to set @var{to-list} and/or @var{to-address} in group
11778 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
11779 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
11780 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
11781 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @var{to-list} or
11782 @var{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
11784 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
11785 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @var{extra-aliases} group
11786 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
11787 rather use a regular expression, set @var{split-regexp}.
11789 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
11790 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
11791 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
11792 @var{to-list}, @var{to-address}, all of @var{extra-aliases} and all
11793 matches of @var{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
11794 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
11795 @var{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
11797 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
11798 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
11799 parameter @var{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
11800 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
11801 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @var{split-spec} may be set to
11802 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
11803 @code{gnus-group-split}.
11805 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
11806 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
11807 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
11808 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
11809 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
11810 some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
11811 that group is used as the catch-all group. Note that, in this case,
11812 there's no cross-posting, as a @code{|} fancy split encloses the
11813 @code{&} split and the catch-all group.
11815 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
11820 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
11821 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
11823 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
11824 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
11825 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
11826 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
11828 ((split-spec . catch-all))
11831 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
11832 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
11833 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
11836 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
11837 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
11838 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
11842 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
11843 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
11844 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
11848 (: gnus-mlsplt-fancy GROUPS NO-CROSSPOST CATCH-ALL)
11851 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
11852 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
11853 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
11854 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} may be the name
11855 of a group to be used as the default catch-all group. If
11856 @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @var{split-regexp} matches the
11857 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
11858 Otherwise, if some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
11859 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
11861 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
11862 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
11863 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
11864 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
11865 used to select @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
11866 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
11867 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
11868 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
11869 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
11871 @findex gnus-group-split-update
11872 However, if you change group parameters, you have to update
11873 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
11874 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
11875 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
11876 you. For example, add to your @file{.gnus}:
11879 (gnus-group-split-setup AUTO-UPDATE CATCH-ALL)
11882 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
11883 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
11884 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
11885 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional),
11886 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
11889 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
11890 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
11891 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
11892 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
11894 @node Incorporating Old Mail
11895 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
11897 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
11898 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
11899 backends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
11902 Doing so can be quite easy.
11904 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
11905 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
11906 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
11907 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
11908 your @code{nnml} groups.
11914 Go to the group buffer.
11917 Type `G f' and give the path to the mbox file when prompted to create an
11918 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
11921 Type `SPACE' to enter the newly created group.
11924 Type `M P b' to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
11925 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
11928 Type `B r' to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
11929 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
11932 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
11933 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
11934 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
11935 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
11936 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
11938 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
11939 backend to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
11940 using the new mail backend.
11943 @node Expiring Mail
11944 @subsection Expiring Mail
11945 @cindex article expiry
11947 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
11948 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
11949 different approach to mail reading.
11951 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
11952 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
11953 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
11954 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
11955 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
11956 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
11959 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
11960 articles as @dfn{expirable}. This does not mean that the articles will
11961 disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
11962 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
11963 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
11964 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
11965 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
11966 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
11968 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
11969 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Groups that
11970 match the regular expression @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will
11971 have all articles that you read marked as expirable automatically. All
11972 articles marked as expirable have an @samp{E} in the first
11973 column in the summary buffer.
11975 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
11976 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
11977 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
11978 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
11981 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
11983 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
11984 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
11985 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
11988 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
11989 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
11990 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
11991 groups expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
11992 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
11994 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
11995 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
11998 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
11999 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
12002 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
12003 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
12005 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
12006 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
12007 don't really mix very well.
12009 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
12010 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
12011 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
12012 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
12015 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
12016 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
12017 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
12018 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
12021 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
12023 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
12025 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
12027 ((string= group "mail.junk")
12029 ((string= group "important")
12035 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
12036 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
12038 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
12039 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
12040 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
12043 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
12044 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
12046 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
12047 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
12048 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them to
12049 other groups instead of deleting them. The variable @code{nnmail-expiry-target}
12050 (and the @code{expiry-target} group parameter) controls this. The
12051 variable supplies a default value for all groups, which can be
12052 overridden for specific groups by the group parameter.
12053 default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a string (which
12054 should be the name of the group the message should be moved to), or a
12055 function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to the message in
12056 question, and with the name of the group being moved from as its
12057 parameter) which should return a target -- either a group name or
12060 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
12062 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
12066 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
12067 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
12068 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
12069 easier for procmail users.
12071 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
12072 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
12073 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
12074 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
12075 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
12076 caution. Even more dangerous is the
12077 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
12078 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
12079 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
12080 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
12081 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
12082 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
12083 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
12086 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
12088 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
12089 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
12090 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
12091 auto-expire turned on.
12095 @subsection Washing Mail
12096 @cindex mail washing
12097 @cindex list server brain damage
12098 @cindex incoming mail treatment
12100 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
12101 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
12102 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
12103 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
12104 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
12105 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
12107 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
12108 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
12109 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
12112 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
12113 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
12114 storing the mail to disc. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
12115 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
12118 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
12119 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
12120 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
12121 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
12122 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
12125 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
12126 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
12127 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
12128 Emacs running on MS machines.
12132 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
12133 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
12134 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
12135 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
12138 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
12139 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
12140 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
12141 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
12143 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
12144 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
12145 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
12146 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
12147 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
12148 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
12149 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
12152 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
12153 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
12156 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
12157 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
12160 This can also be done non-destructively with
12161 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
12163 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
12164 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
12165 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
12167 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
12168 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
12170 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
12171 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
12172 @code{References} headers.
12176 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
12177 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
12178 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
12182 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
12183 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
12184 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
12191 @subsection Duplicates
12193 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
12194 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
12195 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
12196 @cindex duplicate mails
12197 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
12198 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
12199 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
12200 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
12201 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
12202 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
12203 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
12204 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
12205 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
12206 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
12207 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
12208 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
12209 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
12211 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
12212 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
12213 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
12214 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
12216 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
12219 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
12220 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
12224 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
12225 '(| ;; Messages duplicates go to a separate group.
12226 ("gnus-warning" "duplication of message" "duplicate")
12227 ;; Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.
12228 (any mail "mail.misc")
12235 (setq nnmail-split-methods
12236 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:")
12241 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
12242 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
12243 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
12244 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
12245 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
12248 @node Not Reading Mail
12249 @subsection Not Reading Mail
12251 If you start using any of the mail backends, they have the annoying
12252 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
12253 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
12255 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
12256 @code{nil}, none of the backends will ever attempt to read incoming
12257 mail, which should help.
12259 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12260 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
12261 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
12262 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
12263 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
12264 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
12265 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old @sc{rmail}
12266 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All backends have
12267 variables called backend-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
12268 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
12269 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
12271 All the mail backends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
12272 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
12276 @node Choosing a Mail Backend
12277 @subsection Choosing a Mail Backend
12279 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
12280 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
12281 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
12283 There are five different mail backends in the standard Gnus, and more
12284 backends are available separately. The mail backend most people use
12285 (because it is the fastest and most flexible) is @code{nnml}
12286 (@pxref{Mail Spool}).
12289 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
12290 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
12291 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
12292 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like backend.
12293 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
12294 * Comparing Mail Backends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
12298 @node Unix Mail Box
12299 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
12301 @cindex unix mail box
12303 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
12304 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
12305 The @dfn{nnmbox} backend will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
12306 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
12307 which group it belongs in.
12309 Virtual server settings:
12312 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
12313 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
12314 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory.
12316 @item nnmbox-active-file
12317 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
12318 The name of the active file for the mail box.
12320 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
12321 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
12322 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
12328 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
12332 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
12333 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
12334 The @dfn{nnbabyl} backend will use a babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{rmail
12335 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
12336 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
12338 Virtual server settings:
12341 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
12342 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
12343 The name of the rmail mbox file.
12345 @item nnbabyl-active-file
12346 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
12347 The name of the active file for the rmail box.
12349 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12350 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12351 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail.
12356 @subsubsection Mail Spool
12358 @cindex mail @sc{nov} spool
12360 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
12361 format. It should be used with some caution.
12363 @vindex nnml-directory
12364 If you use this backend, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
12365 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
12366 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
12367 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
12369 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
12372 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
12373 in your account, you should not use this backend. As each mail gets its
12374 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
12375 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
12376 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
12377 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
12378 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
12379 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
12381 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest backend when it comes to article
12382 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
12383 @sc{nov} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it the fastest
12384 backend when it comes to reading mail.
12386 Virtual server settings:
12389 @item nnml-directory
12390 @vindex nnml-directory
12391 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory.
12393 @item nnml-active-file
12394 @vindex nnml-active-file
12395 The active file for the @code{nnml} server.
12397 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
12398 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
12399 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
12402 @item nnml-get-new-mail
12403 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
12404 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail.
12406 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
12407 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
12408 If non-@code{nil}, this backend will ignore any @sc{nov} files.
12410 @item nnml-nov-file-name
12411 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
12412 The name of the @sc{nov} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
12414 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
12415 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
12416 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
12420 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
12421 If your @code{nnml} groups and @sc{nov} files get totally out of whack,
12422 you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
12423 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
12424 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
12425 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
12426 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
12431 @subsubsection MH Spool
12433 @cindex mh-e mail spool
12435 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
12436 @sc{nov} databases and it doesn't keep an active file. This makes
12437 @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower backend than @code{nnml}, but it also
12438 makes it easier to write procmail scripts for.
12440 Virtual server settings:
12443 @item nnmh-directory
12444 @vindex nnmh-directory
12445 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory.
12447 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
12448 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
12449 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail.
12452 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
12453 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
12454 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks they
12455 are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
12456 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
12457 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not have
12458 to set this variable to @code{t}.
12463 @subsubsection Mail Folders
12465 @cindex mbox folders
12466 @cindex mail folders
12468 @code{nnfolder} is a backend for storing each mail group in a separate
12469 file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format. @code{nnfolder}
12470 will add extra headers to keep track of article numbers and arrival
12473 Virtual server settings:
12476 @item nnfolder-directory
12477 @vindex nnfolder-directory
12478 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this directory.
12480 @item nnfolder-active-file
12481 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
12482 The name of the active file.
12484 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
12485 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
12486 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File Format}.
12488 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
12489 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
12490 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail.
12492 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
12493 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
12494 @cindex backup files
12495 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
12496 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If you
12497 wish to switch this off, you could say something like the following in
12498 your @file{.emacs} file:
12501 (defun turn-off-backup ()
12502 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
12504 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
12507 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
12508 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
12509 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
12510 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
12511 extract some information from it before removing it.
12516 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
12517 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
12518 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
12519 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
12520 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
12521 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
12524 @node Comparing Mail Backends
12525 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Backends
12527 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{backend} is the common word for a
12528 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
12529 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
12530 and so selection of a suitable backend is required in order to get that
12531 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
12533 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
12534 typically done by @sc{nntp} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
12535 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
12536 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @sc{nntp} server), and
12537 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
12538 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
12539 @code{nnspool} backends, to select between these methods, if one happens
12540 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
12543 The goal in selecting a mail backend is to pick one which
12544 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
12545 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
12546 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
12551 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
12552 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
12553 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
12554 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
12555 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
12556 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
12557 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
12558 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
12559 this backend, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
12560 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
12561 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
12562 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
12563 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
12568 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
12569 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
12570 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
12571 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
12572 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
12573 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
12574 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
12575 RMAIL was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
12576 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote RMAIL
12577 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
12578 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
12579 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
12580 headers/status bits stuff. RMAIL itself still exists as well, of
12581 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
12583 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
12584 filesystem, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
12589 @code{nnml} is the backend which smells the most as though you were
12590 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
12591 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
12592 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
12593 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
12594 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
12595 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
12596 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
12597 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
12598 @sc{nntp} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
12599 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
12600 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
12601 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
12602 provided by the active file and overviews.
12604 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
12605 resource which defines available places in the filesystem to put new
12606 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
12607 tight, shared filesystems. But if you live on a personal machine where
12608 the filesystem is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
12611 It is also problematic using this backend if you are living in a
12612 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
12617 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
12618 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
12619 individual files, but with little or no indexing support -- @code{nnmh}
12620 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
12621 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
12622 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
12623 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
12627 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
12628 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
12629 itself puts *all* one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
12630 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
12631 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
12632 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
12633 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
12634 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
12635 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
12637 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
12638 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
12639 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
12640 friendly mail backend all over.
12645 @node Browsing the Web
12646 @section Browsing the Web
12648 @cindex browsing the web
12652 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
12653 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
12654 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
12655 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
12656 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
12657 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
12658 even know what a news group is.
12660 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
12661 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
12662 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
12663 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
12664 you mad in the end.
12666 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
12669 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of backends for providing
12670 interfaces to these sources.
12673 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
12674 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
12675 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
12676 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
12677 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
12680 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
12682 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
12683 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @sc{html} data
12684 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus backend
12685 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these backends,
12686 though, you should be ok.
12688 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
12689 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
12690 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
12691 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
12692 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
12696 @subsection Web Searches
12700 @cindex InReference
12701 @cindex Usenet searches
12702 @cindex searching the Usenet
12704 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
12705 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
12706 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
12707 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
12708 searches without having to use a browser.
12710 The @code{nnweb} backend allows an easy interface to the mighty search
12711 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
12712 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
12713 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
12714 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
12716 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
12717 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
12718 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
12719 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
12720 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
12721 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
12722 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
12723 engines (DejaNews, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
12724 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
12725 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
12728 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
12729 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
12730 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
12731 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
12732 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
12733 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
12735 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
12736 to use @code{nnweb}.
12738 Virtual server variables:
12743 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
12744 are @code{dejanews}, @code{dejanewsold}, @code{altavista} and
12748 @vindex nnweb-search
12749 The search string to feed to the search engine.
12751 @item nnweb-max-hits
12752 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
12753 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
12756 @item nnweb-type-definition
12757 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
12758 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
12759 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
12764 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
12768 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
12771 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
12774 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
12778 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
12785 @subsection Slashdot
12789 Slashdot (@file{http://slashdot.org/}) is a popular news site, with
12790 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
12791 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
12793 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
12794 following in your @file{.gnus.el} file:
12797 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
12798 '((nnslashdot "")))
12801 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} backend for new comments
12802 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
12803 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
12804 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
12805 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
12808 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
12809 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12811 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
12812 comments), some light @sc{html}izations will be performed. In
12813 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
12814 @code{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @code{br} added to
12815 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @sc{html}
12816 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
12819 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
12822 @item nnslashdot-threaded
12823 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
12824 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
12825 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
12826 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
12827 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
12828 but much, much slower than untreaded.
12830 @item nnslashdot-login-name
12831 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
12832 The login name to use when posting.
12834 @item nnslashdot-password
12835 @vindex nnslashdot-password
12836 The password to use when posting.
12838 @item nnslashdot-directory
12839 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
12840 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default value is
12841 @samp{~/News/slashdot/}.
12843 @item nnslashdot-active-url
12844 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
12845 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the information on
12846 news articles and comments. The default is
12847 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
12849 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
12850 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
12851 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch comments. The
12853 @samp{http://slashdot.org/comments.pl?sid=%s&threshold=%d&commentsort=%d&mode=flat&startat=%d}.
12855 @item nnslashdot-article-url
12856 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
12857 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the news article. The
12859 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
12861 @item nnslashdot-threshold
12862 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
12863 The score threshold. The default is -1.
12865 @item nnslashdot-group-number
12866 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
12867 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
12868 updated. The default is 0.
12875 @subsection Ultimate
12877 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
12879 The Ultimate Bulletin Board (@file{http://www.ultimatebb.com/}) is
12880 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
12881 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
12882 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
12884 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
12885 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
12886 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @sc{url}
12887 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
12888 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
12889 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
12890 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
12892 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
12895 @item nnultimate-directory
12896 @vindex nnultimate-directory
12897 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is
12898 @samp{~/News/ultimate/}.
12903 @subsection Web Archive
12905 @cindex Web Archive
12907 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
12908 @file{http://www.egroups.com/} and
12909 @file{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
12910 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
12913 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
12914 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
12915 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET an_egroup RET egroups RET
12916 www.egroups.com RET your@@email.address RET}. (Substitute the
12917 @sc{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
12918 @sc{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
12919 backend by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
12921 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
12924 @item nnwarchive-directory
12925 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
12926 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is
12927 @samp{~/News/warchive/}.
12929 @item nnwarchive-login
12930 @vindex nnwarchive-login
12931 The account name on the web server.
12933 @item nnwarchive-passwd
12934 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
12935 The password for your account on the web server.
12939 @node Customizing w3
12940 @subsection Customizing w3
12946 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
12947 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
12948 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
12950 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
12951 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
12952 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
12955 (eval-after-load "w3"
12957 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
12958 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
12959 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
12960 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
12962 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
12965 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
12966 @sc{html} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
12970 @node Other Sources
12971 @section Other Sources
12973 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
12974 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
12978 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
12979 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
12980 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
12981 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
12982 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
12983 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
12987 @node Directory Groups
12988 @subsection Directory Groups
12990 @cindex directory groups
12992 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
12993 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
12996 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
12997 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
12998 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
12999 backend to read directories. Big deal.
13001 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
13002 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
13003 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
13004 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
13005 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
13007 @code{nndir} will use @sc{nov} files if they are present.
13009 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' backend---you can't delete or expire
13010 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
13011 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
13012 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
13015 @node Anything Groups
13016 @subsection Anything Groups
13019 From the @code{nndir} backend (which reads a single spool-like
13020 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
13021 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
13024 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
13025 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
13026 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
13027 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
13028 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
13029 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
13030 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
13031 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
13032 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
13033 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
13036 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
13037 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
13038 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
13039 in the article buffer, just as usual.
13041 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
13042 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
13043 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
13044 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
13046 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
13047 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
13048 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
13049 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
13050 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
13051 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
13052 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
13053 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
13058 @item nneething-map-file-directory
13059 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
13060 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
13061 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
13063 @item nneething-exclude-files
13064 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
13065 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
13066 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
13068 @item nneething-include-files
13069 @vindex nneething-include-files
13070 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
13071 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
13073 @item nneething-map-file
13074 @vindex nneething-map-file
13075 Name of the map files.
13079 @node Document Groups
13080 @subsection Document Groups
13082 @cindex documentation group
13085 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
13086 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
13093 The babyl (rmail) mail box.
13098 The standard Unix mbox file.
13100 @cindex MMDF mail box
13102 The MMDF mail box format.
13105 Several news articles appended into a file.
13108 @cindex rnews batch files
13109 The rnews batch transport format.
13110 @cindex forwarded messages
13113 Forwarded articles.
13116 Netscape mail boxes.
13119 MIME multipart messages.
13121 @item standard-digest
13122 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
13125 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
13128 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
13129 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
13130 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
13133 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
13134 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
13135 group. And that's it.
13137 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
13138 new & spiffy Gnus mail backend, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
13139 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
13140 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
13141 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
13142 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
13143 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
13144 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
13145 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
13146 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
13148 Virtual server variables:
13151 @item nndoc-article-type
13152 @vindex nndoc-article-type
13153 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
13154 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
13155 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
13156 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail} or @code{guess}.
13158 @item nndoc-post-type
13159 @vindex nndoc-post-type
13160 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
13161 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
13166 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
13170 @node Document Server Internals
13171 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
13173 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
13174 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
13175 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
13176 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
13178 First, here's an example document type definition:
13182 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
13183 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
13186 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
13187 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
13188 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
13189 types can be defined with very few settings:
13192 @item first-article
13193 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
13194 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
13197 @item article-begin
13198 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
13199 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
13201 @item head-begin-function
13202 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
13205 @item nndoc-head-begin
13206 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
13209 @item nndoc-head-end
13210 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
13211 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
13213 @item body-begin-function
13214 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
13218 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
13221 @item body-end-function
13222 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
13226 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
13229 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
13230 regexp will be totally ignored.
13234 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
13235 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
13236 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
13237 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
13238 something that's palatable for Gnus:
13241 @item prepare-body-function
13242 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
13243 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
13244 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
13246 @item article-transform-function
13247 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
13248 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
13249 body of the article.
13251 @item generate-head-function
13252 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
13253 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
13254 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
13255 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
13259 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
13264 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
13265 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
13266 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
13267 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
13268 (head-end . "^ ?$")
13269 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
13270 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
13271 (subtype digest guess))
13274 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
13275 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
13276 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
13277 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
13278 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
13280 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
13281 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first is
13282 the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says where in
13283 the document type definition alist to put this definition. The alist is
13284 traversed sequentially, and @code{nndoc-TYPE-type-p} is called for a given type @code{TYPE}. So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document
13285 is of @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
13286 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it is
13287 of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
13288 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number means
13289 low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
13297 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
13298 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
13299 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
13301 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
13302 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
13303 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
13306 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
13307 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
13308 that interested in doing things properly.
13310 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
13311 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
13314 First some terminology:
13319 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
13320 get news and/or mail from.
13323 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
13324 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
13327 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
13331 @item message packets
13332 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
13333 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
13334 default, where @var{x} is a number.
13336 @item response packets
13337 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
13338 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
13339 default, where @var{x} is a number.
13349 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
13350 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
13351 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
13352 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
13355 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
13358 You put the packet in your home directory.
13361 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} backend as
13362 the native or secondary server.
13365 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
13366 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
13369 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
13373 You transfer this packet to the server.
13376 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
13379 You then repeat until you die.
13383 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
13384 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
13387 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
13388 * SOUP Groups:: A backend for reading @sc{soup} packets.
13389 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
13393 @node SOUP Commands
13394 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
13396 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
13400 @kindex G s b (Group)
13401 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
13402 Pack all unread articles in the current group
13403 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
13404 process/prefix convention.
13407 @kindex G s w (Group)
13408 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
13409 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
13412 @kindex G s s (Group)
13413 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
13414 Send all replies from the replies packet
13415 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
13418 @kindex G s p (Group)
13419 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
13420 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
13423 @kindex G s r (Group)
13424 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
13425 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
13428 @kindex O s (Summary)
13429 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
13430 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
13431 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
13432 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
13437 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
13442 @item gnus-soup-directory
13443 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
13444 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
13445 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
13447 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
13448 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
13449 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
13450 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
13452 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
13453 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
13454 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
13455 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
13457 @item gnus-soup-packer
13458 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
13459 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
13460 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
13462 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
13463 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
13464 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
13465 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
13467 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
13468 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
13469 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
13471 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
13472 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
13473 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
13474 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
13480 @subsubsection @sc{soup} Groups
13483 @code{nnsoup} is the backend for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
13484 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
13485 you can read them at leisure.
13487 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
13491 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
13492 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
13493 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
13494 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
13496 @item nnsoup-directory
13497 @vindex nnsoup-directory
13498 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
13499 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
13501 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
13502 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
13503 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
13504 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/"}.
13506 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
13507 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
13508 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
13509 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
13510 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
13512 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
13513 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
13514 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
13515 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
13517 @item nnsoup-active-file
13518 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
13519 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
13520 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
13521 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
13522 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
13524 @item nnsoup-packer
13525 @vindex nnsoup-packer
13526 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
13527 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
13529 @item nnsoup-unpacker
13530 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
13531 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
13532 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
13534 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
13535 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
13536 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
13539 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
13540 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
13541 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
13544 @item nnsoup-always-save
13545 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
13546 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
13552 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
13554 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
13555 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
13556 more for that to happen.
13558 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
13559 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
13560 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
13563 In specific, this is what it does:
13566 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
13567 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
13570 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
13571 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
13572 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
13575 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
13576 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
13577 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
13580 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
13581 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
13582 The @code{nngateway} backend provides the interface.
13584 Note that you can't read anything from this backend---it can only be
13590 @item nngateway-address
13591 @vindex nngateway-address
13592 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
13594 @item nngateway-header-transformation
13595 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
13596 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
13597 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
13598 transformation should be called, and defaults to
13599 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
13600 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
13603 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
13604 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
13605 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
13608 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
13611 will get this @code{From} header inserted:
13614 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
13617 The following pre-defined functions exist:
13619 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
13622 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
13623 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
13624 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
13626 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
13628 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
13629 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
13630 @code{nngateway-address}.
13635 (setq gnus-post-method
13636 '(nngateway "mail2news@@replay.com"
13637 (nngateway-header-transformation
13638 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
13646 So, to use this, simply say something like:
13649 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
13655 @subsection @sc{imap}
13659 @sc{imap} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or ...),
13660 think of it as a modernized @sc{nntp}. Connecting to a @sc{imap} server
13661 is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just specify the
13662 network address of the server.
13664 A server configuration in @code{~/.gnus} with a few @sc{imap} servers
13665 might look something like this:
13668 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
13669 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; no special configuration
13670 ; perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:
13672 (nnimap-address "localhost")
13673 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
13674 ; a UW server running on localhost
13676 (nnimap-server-port 143)
13677 (nnimap-address "localhost")
13678 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
13679 ; anonymous public cyrus server:
13680 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
13681 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
13682 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
13683 (nnimap-stream network))
13684 ; a ssl server on a non-standard port:
13686 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
13687 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
13688 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
13691 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
13696 @item nnimap-address
13697 @vindex nnimap-address
13699 The address of the remote @sc{imap} server. Defaults to the virtual
13700 server name if not specified.
13702 @item nnimap-server-port
13703 @vindex nnimap-server-port
13704 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for SSL.
13706 Note that this should be a integer, example server specification:
13709 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13710 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
13713 @item nnimap-list-pattern
13714 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
13715 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
13716 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
13717 interested in a few -- some servers export your home directory via
13718 @sc{imap}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
13719 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
13721 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
13722 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
13723 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
13726 Example server specification:
13729 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13730 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
13731 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
13734 @item nnimap-stream
13735 @vindex nnimap-stream
13736 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
13737 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
13738 of SSL. (SSL is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can be automatically
13739 detected, but it's not widely deployed yet).
13741 Example server specification:
13744 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13745 (nnimap-stream ssl))
13748 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
13752 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5). Require the
13753 @samp{imtest} program.
13755 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with kerberos 4. Require the @samp{imtest} program.
13757 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
13758 SSL). Require the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
13761 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through SSL. Require OpenSSL (the
13762 program @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
13764 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start IMAP connection.
13766 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
13769 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
13770 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD, nnimap support
13771 both @samp{imtest} version 1.5.x and version 1.6.x. The variable
13772 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
13775 @vindex imap-ssl-program
13776 For SSL connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
13777 @file{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
13778 and nnimap support it too - altough the most recent versions of
13779 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
13780 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
13781 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
13784 @vindex imap-shell-program
13785 @vindex imap-shell-host
13786 For IMAP connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
13787 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
13789 @item nnimap-authenticator
13790 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
13792 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
13793 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
13795 Example server specification:
13798 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13799 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
13802 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
13806 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Require
13807 external program @code{imtest}.
13809 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos authentication. Require external program
13812 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Require
13813 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
13815 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
13817 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
13819 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as `anonymous', supplying your emailadress as password.
13822 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
13824 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
13825 Unlike Parmenides the @sc{imap} designers has decided that things that
13826 doesn't exist actually does exist. More specifically, @sc{imap} has
13827 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
13828 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
13829 nnimap does when you delete a article in Gnus (with @kbd{G DEL} or
13832 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
13833 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
13834 running in circles yet?
13836 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
13837 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
13840 The possible options are:
13845 The default behaviour, delete all articles marked as "Deleted" when
13848 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
13849 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @sc{imap} clients
13850 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
13851 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
13853 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
13858 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
13859 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
13861 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format
13862 is (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See
13863 `nntp-authinfo-file' for exact syntax.
13865 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
13866 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
13867 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
13873 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
13874 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
13875 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
13880 @node Splitting in IMAP
13881 @subsubsection Splitting in @sc{imap}
13882 @cindex splitting imap mail
13884 Splitting is something Gnus users has loved and used for years, and now
13885 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
13886 @sc{imap} server has server side splitting and those that have splitting
13887 seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that @sc{imap}
13888 support for Gnus has to do it's own splitting.
13892 Here are the variables of interest:
13896 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
13897 @cindex splitting, crosspost
13899 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
13901 If non-nil, do crossposting if several split methods match the mail. If
13902 nil, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule} found will be used.
13904 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
13906 @item nnimap-split-inbox
13907 @cindex splitting, inbox
13909 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
13911 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @sc{imap}
13912 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to nil, which means that splitting is
13916 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
13917 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
13920 No nnmail equivalent.
13922 @item nnimap-split-rule
13923 @cindex Splitting, rules
13924 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
13926 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
13929 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
13930 sublist gives the name of the @sc{imap} mailbox to move articles
13931 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
13932 Neither did I, we need examples.
13935 (setq nnimap-split-rule
13936 '(("INBOX.nnimap" "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
13937 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
13938 ("INBOX.private" "")))
13941 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
13942 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
13943 into INBOX.spam and everything else in INBOX.private.
13945 The first string may contain `\\1' forms, like the ones used by
13946 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
13950 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
13953 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13954 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
13955 containing the headers of the article. It should return a non-nil value
13956 if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
13958 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
13959 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
13960 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
13961 of your inbox. (This might might affect performance if you keep lots of
13962 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
13963 them every time you fetch new mail.)
13965 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
13966 end. The first rule to make a match will "win", unless you have
13967 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will "win".
13969 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
13970 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
13971 thinks the article should be splitted to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
13973 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it need too.
13975 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
13976 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
13977 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
13980 (setq nnimap-split-rule
13981 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
13982 ("junk" "From:.*Simon")))
13983 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
13984 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
13985 ("junk" my-junk-func)))))
13988 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
13989 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
13990 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
13991 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
13992 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
13993 group/function elements.
13995 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
13997 @item nnimap-split-predicate
13999 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
14001 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
14002 splitted, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
14004 This might be useful if you use another @sc{imap} client to read mail in
14005 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
14006 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
14009 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14010 @cindex splitting, fancy
14011 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
14012 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
14014 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
14015 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
14016 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14018 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
14019 nnimap backends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
14020 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
14021 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
14026 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
14027 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
14030 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14034 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
14035 @subsubsection Editing @sc{imap} ACLs
14036 @cindex editing imap acls
14037 @cindex Access Control Lists
14038 @cindex Editing @sc{imap} ACLs
14040 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
14042 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @sc{imap} for
14043 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
14044 @sc{imap} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
14047 To edit a ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
14048 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with a ACL
14049 editing window with detailed instructions.
14051 Some possible uses:
14055 Giving "anyone" the "lrs" rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
14056 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
14057 follow the list without subscribing to it.
14059 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
14060 "anyone" posting ("p") capabilities to have "plussing" work (that is,
14061 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @sc{imap} mailbox
14065 @node Expunging mailboxes
14066 @subsubsection Expunging mailboxes
14070 @cindex Manual expunging
14072 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
14074 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-close},
14075 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
14076 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
14078 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
14083 @node Combined Groups
14084 @section Combined Groups
14086 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
14090 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
14091 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
14095 @node Virtual Groups
14096 @subsection Virtual Groups
14098 @cindex virtual groups
14099 @cindex merging groups
14101 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
14104 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
14105 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
14106 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
14108 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
14109 regexp to match component groups.
14111 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
14112 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
14113 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it came.
14114 (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be shown in
14115 the virtual group.)
14117 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
14118 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
14121 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
14124 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
14125 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
14127 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
14128 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
14129 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
14130 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
14133 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
14136 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
14137 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
14138 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
14140 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
14141 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
14142 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
14143 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
14144 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
14146 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
14147 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
14148 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
14150 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
14151 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
14152 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
14153 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
14154 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
14155 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
14156 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
14157 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
14158 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
14159 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
14160 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
14162 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
14163 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
14164 has to ask the backend of the component group the article comes from
14165 whether it is a news or mail backend. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
14166 there is typically no sure way for the component backend to know this,
14167 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
14168 not-news backend. (Just to be on the safe side.)
14170 @kbd{C-c C-t} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
14171 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
14175 @node Kibozed Groups
14176 @subsection Kibozed Groups
14180 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by @sc{oed} as ``grepping through (parts of)
14181 the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a backend that will do this for
14182 you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @sc{nntp} server down to a halt
14183 with useless requests! Oh happiness!
14185 @kindex G k (Group)
14186 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
14189 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
14190 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
14191 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between @code{nnkiboze}
14192 and @code{nnvirtual} end.
14194 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an @code{nnkiboze} group
14195 must have a score file to say what articles are to be included in
14196 the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
14198 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
14199 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
14200 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
14201 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time. Lots of
14202 time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the headers from
14203 all the articles in all the component groups and run them through the
14204 scoring process to determine if there are any articles in the groups
14205 that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
14207 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
14208 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
14209 @sc{nntp} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
14210 Stranger things have happened.
14212 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
14213 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
14215 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
14216 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
14217 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/} by default. One
14218 contains the @sc{nov} header lines for all the articles in the group,
14219 and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store information
14220 on what groups have been searched through to find component articles.
14222 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
14223 their @sc{nov} lines removed from the @sc{nov} file.
14226 @node Gnus Unplugged
14227 @section Gnus Unplugged
14232 @cindex Gnus Unplugged
14234 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
14235 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
14236 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
14237 read news. Believe it or not.
14239 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
14240 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
14241 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
14242 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
14243 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
14245 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
14246 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
14247 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
14248 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
14249 reading news on a machine.
14251 Using Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple.
14255 First, set up Gnus as you would do if you were running it on a machine
14256 that has full connection to the net. Go ahead. I'll still be waiting
14260 Then, put the following magical incantation at the end of your
14261 @file{.gnus.el} file:
14268 That's it. Gnus is now an ``offline'' newsreader.
14270 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
14273 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
14274 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
14275 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
14276 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
14277 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
14278 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
14279 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
14280 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
14281 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
14282 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
14287 @subsection Agent Basics
14289 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
14291 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
14292 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
14293 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
14294 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
14296 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
14297 connected to the net continuously.
14299 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
14300 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
14302 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
14307 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
14308 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
14309 already fetched while in this mode.
14312 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
14313 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
14314 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
14315 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode, see (@pxref{Mail
14316 Source Specifiers}).
14319 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the news
14320 onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press @kbd{g}
14321 to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J
14322 s} to fetch all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus
14323 know which articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}.)
14326 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
14327 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
14328 then you read the news offline.
14331 And then you go to step 2.
14334 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
14340 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
14341 backend, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
14342 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
14343 @kbd{J a} the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
14344 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}). This will typically be only the
14345 primary select method, which is listed on the bottom in the buffer.
14348 Decide on download policy. @xref{Agent Categories}.
14355 @node Agent Categories
14356 @subsection Agent Categories
14358 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
14359 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
14360 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
14361 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
14362 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
14363 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
14364 you're interested in the articles anyway.
14366 The main way to control what is to be downloaded is to create a
14367 @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all) groups to this category.
14368 Groups that do not belong in any other category belong to the
14369 @code{default} category. Gnus has its own buffer for creating and
14370 managing categories.
14373 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
14374 * The Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
14375 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
14379 @node Category Syntax
14380 @subsubsection Category Syntax
14382 A category consists of two things.
14386 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
14387 are eligible for downloading; and
14390 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
14391 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
14392 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
14395 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
14396 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
14397 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
14398 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
14400 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
14401 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
14402 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as descibed below.
14404 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
14405 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
14406 operators sprinkled in between.
14408 Perhaps some examples are in order.
14410 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
14411 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
14417 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
14418 short (for some value of ``short'').
14420 Here's a more complex predicate:
14429 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
14430 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
14433 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
14434 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
14435 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
14437 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
14438 you want to do, you can write your own.
14442 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
14443 lines; default 100.
14446 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
14447 lines; default 200.
14450 True iff the article has a download score less than
14451 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
14454 True iff the article has a download score greater than
14455 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
14458 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
14459 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
14460 checksum and sees whether articles match.
14469 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
14470 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
14471 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
14474 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
14475 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
14476 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
14477 something along the lines of the following:
14480 (defun my-article-old-p ()
14481 "Say whether an article is old."
14482 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
14483 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
14486 with the predicate then defined as:
14489 (not my-article-old-p)
14492 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
14493 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
14494 wherever. (Note: this would have to be at a point *after*
14495 @code{gnus-agent} has been loaded via @code{(gnus-agentize)})
14498 (defvar gnus-category-predicate-alist
14499 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
14500 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
14503 and simply specify your predicate as:
14509 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
14510 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
14511 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
14512 just don't give a damm.
14514 The above predicates apply to *all* the groups which belong to the
14515 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
14516 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
14517 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in it's group
14518 parameters like so:
14521 (agent-predicate . short)
14524 This is the group parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
14525 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
14526 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
14528 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
14531 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
14534 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
14535 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
14536 predicate is assumed to be a list.
14539 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
14540 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
14541 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
14542 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
14543 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
14544 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
14546 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
14547 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
14548 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
14549 if it's to be specific to that group.
14551 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
14558 This has the same syntax as a normal gnus score file except only a
14559 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
14565 Category specification
14569 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
14575 Group Parameter specification
14578 (agent-score ("from"
14579 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
14584 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
14590 These score files must *only* contain the permitted scoring keywords
14597 Category specification
14600 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
14606 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
14610 Group Parameter specification
14613 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
14616 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
14621 Use @code{normal} score files
14623 If you dont want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
14624 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
14625 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
14626 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
14628 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
14629 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
14630 files for a group, *filtering out* those those sections that do not
14631 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
14635 Category Specification
14642 Group Parameter specification
14645 (agent-score . file)
14650 @node The Category Buffer
14651 @subsubsection The Category Buffer
14653 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
14654 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
14655 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
14657 The following commands are available in this buffer:
14661 @kindex q (Category)
14662 @findex gnus-category-exit
14663 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
14666 @kindex k (Category)
14667 @findex gnus-category-kill
14668 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
14671 @kindex c (Category)
14672 @findex gnus-category-copy
14673 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
14676 @kindex a (Category)
14677 @findex gnus-category-add
14678 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
14681 @kindex p (Category)
14682 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
14683 Edit the predicate of the current category
14684 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
14687 @kindex g (Category)
14688 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
14689 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
14690 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
14693 @kindex s (Category)
14694 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
14695 Edit the download score rule of the current category
14696 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
14699 @kindex l (Category)
14700 @findex gnus-category-list
14701 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
14705 @node Category Variables
14706 @subsubsection Category Variables
14709 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
14710 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
14711 Hook run in category buffers.
14713 @item gnus-category-line-format
14714 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
14715 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
14716 Variables}). Valid elements are:
14720 The name of the category.
14723 The number of groups in the category.
14726 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
14727 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
14728 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
14730 @item gnus-agent-short-article
14731 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
14732 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
14734 @item gnus-agent-long-article
14735 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
14736 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
14738 @item gnus-agent-low-score
14739 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
14740 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
14743 @item gnus-agent-high-score
14744 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
14745 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
14751 @node Agent Commands
14752 @subsection Agent Commands
14754 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
14755 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged} command works in all modes, and
14756 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
14760 * Group Agent Commands::
14761 * Summary Agent Commands::
14762 * Server Agent Commands::
14765 You can run a complete batch fetch from the command line with the
14766 following incantation:
14768 @cindex gnus-agent-batch-fetch
14770 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch-fetch
14775 @node Group Agent Commands
14776 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
14780 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
14781 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
14782 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
14783 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
14786 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
14787 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
14788 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
14791 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
14792 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
14793 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
14794 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
14797 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
14798 @findex gnus-group-send-drafts
14799 Send all sendable messages in the draft group
14800 (@code{gnus-group-send-drafts}). @xref{Drafts}.
14803 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
14804 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
14805 Add the current group to an Agent category
14806 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
14807 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
14810 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
14811 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
14812 Remove the current group from its category, if any
14813 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
14814 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
14817 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
14818 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
14819 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
14825 @node Summary Agent Commands
14826 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
14830 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
14831 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
14832 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
14835 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
14836 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
14837 Remove the downloading mark from the article
14838 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
14841 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
14842 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
14843 Toggle whether to download the article (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}).
14846 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
14847 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
14848 Mark all undownloaded articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}).
14853 @node Server Agent Commands
14854 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
14858 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
14859 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
14860 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
14861 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
14864 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
14865 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
14866 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
14867 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
14873 @subsection Agent Expiry
14875 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
14876 @findex gnus-agent-expire
14877 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
14878 @cindex Agent expiry
14879 @cindex Gnus Agent expiry
14882 @code{nnagent} doesn't handle expiry. Instead, there's a special
14883 @code{gnus-agent-expire} command that will expire all read articles that
14884 are older than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. It can be run
14885 whenever you feel that you're running out of space. It's not
14886 particularly fast or efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to
14887 interrupt it (with @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started it.
14889 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
14890 if @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, this command will
14891 expire all articles---unread, read, ticked and dormant. If @code{nil}
14892 (which is the default), only read articles are eligible for expiry, and
14893 unread, ticked and dormant articles will be kept indefinitely.
14896 @node Agent and IMAP
14897 @subsection Agent and IMAP
14899 The Agent work with any Gnus backend, including nnimap. However, since
14900 there are some conceptual differences between NNTP and IMAP, this
14901 section (should) provide you with some information to make Gnus Agent
14902 work smoother as a IMAP Disconnected Mode client.
14904 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
14905 are kept on the IMAP server, rather than in @code{.newsrc} as is the
14906 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
14907 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
14909 Gnus keep track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
14910 Agent by default. When you plug back in, by default Gnus will check if
14911 you have any changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize theese
14912 with the server. This behaviour is customizable with
14913 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
14915 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
14916 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
14917 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, the
14918 default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so ask if
14919 you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has any other
14920 value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
14922 If you do not wish to automatically synchronize flags when you
14923 re-connect, this can be done manually with the
14924 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
14925 in the group buffer by default.
14927 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
14928 expect from a disconnected IMAP client, including:
14933 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
14936 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
14940 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by "pushing"
14941 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
14942 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
14943 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on a article, quit the group and
14944 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
14945 removed from the server when you "synchronize". The queued flag
14946 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
14947 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
14950 @node Outgoing Messages
14951 @subsection Outgoing Messages
14953 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
14954 stored in the draft groups (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view them there
14955 after posting, and edit them at will.
14957 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
14958 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
14959 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
14960 messages in the draft group.
14964 @node Agent Variables
14965 @subsection Agent Variables
14968 @item gnus-agent-directory
14969 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
14970 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
14971 @file{~/News/agent/}.
14973 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
14974 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
14975 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
14976 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
14977 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
14980 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
14981 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
14982 Hook run when connecting to the network.
14984 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
14985 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
14986 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
14991 @node Example Setup
14992 @subsection Example Setup
14994 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
14995 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
14996 @file{.gnus.el} file to get started.
14999 ;;; Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @sc{nntp}
15000 ;;; from your ISP's server.
15001 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
15003 ;;; Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from
15004 ;;; your ISP's POP server.
15005 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
15007 ;;; Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.
15008 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
15010 ;;; Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.
15014 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
15015 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
15018 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
15019 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
15020 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
15021 @sc{nntp} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
15022 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
15025 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
15026 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
15027 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
15028 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
15029 back all the killed groups.)
15031 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
15032 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
15033 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
15036 @node Batching Agents
15037 @subsection Batching Agents
15039 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
15040 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
15041 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
15045 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null
15049 @node Agent Caveats
15050 @subsection Agent Caveats
15052 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
15053 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
15057 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the
15062 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists
15063 in the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
15069 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
15070 articles; when it's plugged, it only talks to your ISP.
15077 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
15078 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
15079 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
15082 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
15083 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
15084 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
15085 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
15086 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
15088 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
15089 before generating the summary buffer.
15091 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
15092 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
15093 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
15095 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
15096 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
15097 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
15098 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
15101 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
15102 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
15103 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
15104 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
15105 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
15106 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
15107 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
15108 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
15109 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
15110 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
15111 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
15112 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
15113 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
15114 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
15115 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
15116 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
15120 @node Summary Score Commands
15121 @section Summary Score Commands
15122 @cindex score commands
15124 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
15125 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
15126 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
15127 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
15128 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
15130 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
15131 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
15132 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
15133 score file the current one.
15135 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
15140 @kindex V s (Summary)
15141 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
15142 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
15145 @kindex V S (Summary)
15146 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
15147 Display the score of the current article
15148 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
15151 @kindex V t (Summary)
15152 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
15153 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
15154 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}).
15157 @kindex V R (Summary)
15158 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
15159 Run the current summary through the scoring process
15160 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
15161 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
15162 effect you're having.
15165 @kindex V c (Summary)
15166 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
15167 Make a different score file the current
15168 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
15171 @kindex V e (Summary)
15172 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
15173 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
15174 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
15178 @kindex V f (Summary)
15179 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
15180 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
15181 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
15184 @kindex V F (Summary)
15185 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
15186 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
15187 after editing score files.
15190 @kindex V C (Summary)
15191 @findex gnus-score-customize
15192 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
15193 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
15197 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
15202 @kindex V m (Summary)
15203 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
15204 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
15205 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
15208 @kindex V x (Summary)
15209 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
15210 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
15211 expunge all articles below this score
15212 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
15215 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
15216 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
15219 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
15220 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
15224 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
15225 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
15227 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
15228 keys are available:
15232 Score on the author name.
15235 Score on the subject line.
15238 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
15241 Score on the @code{References} line.
15247 Score on the number of lines.
15250 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
15253 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
15254 the followups to this author.
15268 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
15269 what headers you are scoring on.
15281 Substring matching.
15284 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
15313 Greater than number.
15318 The fourth and final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e., expiring)
15319 score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry, or whether
15320 it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score file.
15324 Temporary score entry.
15327 Permanent score entry.
15330 Immediately scoring.
15335 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
15336 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
15337 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
15338 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
15340 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
15341 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
15342 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
15343 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
15344 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
15346 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
15347 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
15348 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
15349 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
15350 current score file.
15352 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
15353 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
15354 pretend they are keymaps or not.
15357 @node Group Score Commands
15358 @section Group Score Commands
15359 @cindex group score commands
15361 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
15366 @kindex W f (Group)
15367 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
15368 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
15369 all the time. This command will flush the cache
15370 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
15374 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
15376 @findex gnus-batch-score
15377 @cindex batch scoring
15379 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
15383 @node Score Variables
15384 @section Score Variables
15385 @cindex score variables
15389 @item gnus-use-scoring
15390 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
15391 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
15392 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
15394 @item gnus-kill-killed
15395 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
15396 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
15397 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
15398 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
15399 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
15400 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
15401 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
15403 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
15404 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
15405 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
15406 initialized from the @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
15407 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
15409 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
15410 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
15411 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
15412 (@samp{SCORE} by default.)
15414 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
15415 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
15416 @cindex score cache
15417 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
15418 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
15419 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
15420 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
15421 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
15422 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
15425 @item gnus-save-score
15426 @vindex gnus-save-score
15427 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
15428 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
15429 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
15431 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
15432 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
15433 across group visits.
15435 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
15436 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
15437 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
15438 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
15439 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
15440 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
15441 manually entered data.
15443 @item gnus-summary-default-score
15444 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
15445 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
15447 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
15448 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
15449 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
15450 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
15451 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
15452 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
15454 @item gnus-score-over-mark
15455 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
15456 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
15457 default. Default is @samp{+}.
15459 @item gnus-score-below-mark
15460 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
15461 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
15462 default. Default is @samp{-}.
15464 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
15465 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
15466 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
15467 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
15469 Predefined functions available are:
15472 @item gnus-score-find-single
15473 @findex gnus-score-find-single
15474 Only apply the group's own score file.
15476 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
15477 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
15478 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
15479 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
15480 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
15481 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
15482 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
15483 then a regexp match is done.
15485 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
15486 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
15488 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
15489 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
15490 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
15491 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
15493 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
15494 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
15495 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
15496 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
15497 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
15501 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all these
15502 functions will be called with the group name as argument, and all the
15503 returned lists of score files will be applied. These functions can also
15504 return lists of score alists directly. In that case, the functions that
15505 return these non-file score alists should probably be placed before the
15506 ``real'' score file functions, to ensure that the last score file
15507 returned is the local score file. Phu.
15509 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
15510 overall score file, you could use the value
15512 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE")) 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
15515 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
15516 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
15517 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
15518 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
15519 are expired. It's 7 by default.
15521 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
15522 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
15523 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, matching score entries will have
15524 their dates updated. (This is how Gnus controls expiry---all
15525 non-matching entries will become too old while matching entries will
15526 stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this variable to @code{nil},
15527 even matching entries will grow old and will have to face that oh-so
15530 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
15531 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
15532 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
15534 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
15535 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
15536 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be simplified
15537 for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
15538 threading---according to the current value of
15539 gnus-simplify-subject-functions. If the scoring entry uses
15540 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
15541 simplified in this manner.
15546 @node Score File Format
15547 @section Score File Format
15548 @cindex score file format
15550 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
15551 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
15552 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
15554 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
15558 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
15560 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
15562 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
15564 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
15569 (mark-and-expunge -10)
15573 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
15574 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
15575 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
15576 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
15580 This example demonstrates most score file elements. For a different
15581 approach, see @pxref{Advanced Scoring}.
15583 Even though this looks much like lisp code, nothing here is actually
15584 @code{eval}ed. The lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
15585 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
15587 Six keys are supported by this alist:
15592 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
15593 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
15594 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
15595 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
15596 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
15597 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
15598 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
15599 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
15600 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
15601 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
15602 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
15603 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
15604 to articles that matches these score entries.
15606 Following this key is a arbitrary number of score entries, where each
15607 score entry has one to four elements.
15611 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
15612 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
15616 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
15617 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
15618 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
15619 is successful. If this element is not present, the
15620 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
15621 instead. This is 1000 by default.
15624 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
15625 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
15626 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
15627 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
15628 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
15631 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
15632 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
15633 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
15634 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
15637 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
15638 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
15639 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
15640 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
15641 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
15642 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
15643 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
15644 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
15645 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
15646 instead, if you feel like.
15649 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
15650 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
15652 These predicates are true if
15655 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
15658 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
15659 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
15666 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
15667 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
15668 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
15669 it's not. I think.)
15671 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some backends (like
15672 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
15673 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
15674 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
15677 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
15678 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
15679 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
15680 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
15681 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
15682 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
15683 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
15687 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
15688 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
15689 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
15690 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
15691 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
15692 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
15693 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
15694 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
15697 @item Head, Body, All
15698 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
15702 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
15703 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
15704 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
15705 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
15706 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
15707 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
15708 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
15712 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
15713 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
15714 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
15715 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
15716 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
15717 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
15718 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
15719 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
15720 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
15721 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
15722 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
15726 @cindex Score File Atoms
15728 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15729 lower than this number will be marked as read.
15732 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15733 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
15735 @item mark-and-expunge
15736 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15737 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
15740 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
15741 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
15742 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
15743 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
15744 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
15747 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
15748 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
15751 @item exclude-files
15752 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
15753 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
15757 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
15758 ignored when handling global score files.
15761 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
15762 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
15763 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
15764 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
15767 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
15768 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
15769 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
15770 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
15772 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
15776 (mark-and-expunge -100)
15779 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
15780 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
15781 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
15782 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
15783 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
15785 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where there
15786 exist a few interesting threads which can't be found automatically by
15787 ordinary scoring rules.
15790 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
15791 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
15792 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
15793 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
15794 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
15795 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
15796 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
15797 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
15798 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
15799 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
15800 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
15804 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
15805 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
15806 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
15807 file for a number of groups.
15810 @cindex local variables
15811 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(VAR VALUE)} pairs.
15812 Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the current summary buffer,
15813 and set to the value specified. This is a convenient, if somewhat
15814 strange, way of setting variables in some groups if you don't like hooks
15815 much. Note that the @var{value} won't be evaluated.
15819 @node Score File Editing
15820 @section Score File Editing
15822 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
15823 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
15824 with a mode for that.
15826 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
15827 additional commands:
15832 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
15833 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
15834 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
15835 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
15838 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
15839 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
15840 Insert the current date in numerical format
15841 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
15842 you were wondering.
15845 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
15846 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
15847 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
15848 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
15849 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
15854 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
15856 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
15857 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
15859 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f} and @kbd{V
15860 e} to begin editing score files.
15863 @node Adaptive Scoring
15864 @section Adaptive Scoring
15865 @cindex adaptive scoring
15867 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
15868 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
15869 stupidity, to be precise.
15871 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
15872 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
15873 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
15874 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
15875 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
15876 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
15877 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
15878 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
15879 variable to @code{(word line)}.
15881 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
15882 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
15883 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
15884 might look something like this:
15887 (defvar gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
15888 '((gnus-unread-mark)
15889 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
15890 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
15891 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
15892 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
15893 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
15894 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
15895 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
15896 (gnus-ancient-mark)
15897 (gnus-low-score-mark)
15898 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
15901 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
15902 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
15903 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
15904 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
15905 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
15906 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
15909 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
15910 will be applied to each article.
15912 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
15913 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{D}) will have a
15914 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
15915 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
15917 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
15918 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
15919 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
15920 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
15922 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
15923 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
15924 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
15925 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
15927 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
15928 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
15929 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
15930 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
15931 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
15932 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
15934 You can also score on @code{thread}, which will try to score all
15935 articles that appear in a thread. @code{thread} matches uses a
15936 @code{Message-ID} to match on the @code{References} header of the
15937 article. If the match is made, the @code{Message-ID} of the article is
15938 added to the @code{thread} rule. (Think about it. I'd recommend two
15939 aspirins afterwards.)
15941 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
15942 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
15943 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
15945 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
15946 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
15947 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
15949 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
15950 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
15951 let you use different rules in different groups.
15953 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
15954 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
15955 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
15958 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
15959 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
15960 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
15961 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
15962 the length of the match is less than
15963 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
15964 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
15967 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
15968 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
15969 headers. If you adapt on words, the
15970 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
15971 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
15974 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
15975 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
15976 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
15977 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
15978 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
15981 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
15982 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
15983 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
15984 score with 30 points.
15986 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
15987 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
15988 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
15989 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
15990 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
15992 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
15993 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
15994 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
15995 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
15997 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
15998 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
15999 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
16000 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
16002 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
16003 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
16004 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
16005 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
16006 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
16008 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
16009 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
16010 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
16012 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
16013 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
16014 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
16015 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
16018 @node Home Score File
16019 @section Home Score File
16021 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
16022 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
16023 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
16024 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
16026 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
16027 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
16028 could perhaps use the same home score file.
16030 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
16031 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
16036 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
16040 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
16041 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
16045 A list. The elements in this list can be:
16049 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
16050 group name, the @var{file-name} will will be used as the home score file.
16053 A function. If the function returns non-nil, the result will be used as
16054 the home score file.
16057 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
16060 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
16065 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
16068 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16069 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
16072 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
16073 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
16075 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
16077 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16078 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
16081 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
16082 Other functions include
16085 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
16086 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
16087 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
16088 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
16092 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
16093 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
16094 their own home score files:
16097 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16098 ;; All groups that match the regexp "\\.emacs"
16099 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
16100 ;; All the comp groups in one score file
16101 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
16104 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
16105 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
16106 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
16107 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
16108 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
16110 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
16111 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
16112 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
16113 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
16114 precedence over this variable.
16117 @node Followups To Yourself
16118 @section Followups To Yourself
16120 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
16121 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
16122 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
16123 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
16124 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
16125 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
16129 @item gnus-score-followup-article
16130 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
16131 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
16134 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
16135 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
16136 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
16140 @vindex message-sent-hook
16141 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
16142 @code{message-sent-hook}.
16144 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
16145 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
16149 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
16150 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
16153 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
16154 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
16159 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore.no>"
16163 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
16164 is system-dependent.
16168 @section Scoring Tips
16169 @cindex scoring tips
16175 @cindex scoring crossposts
16176 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
16177 the @code{Xref} header.
16179 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
16182 @item Multiple crossposts
16183 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
16184 more than, say, 3 groups:
16186 ("xref" ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+" -1000 nil r))
16189 @item Matching on the body
16190 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
16191 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
16192 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
16193 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
16194 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
16195 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
16196 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
16199 @item Marking as read
16200 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
16201 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
16202 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
16206 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
16208 @item Negated character classes
16209 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
16210 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
16211 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
16215 @node Reverse Scoring
16216 @section Reverse Scoring
16217 @cindex reverse scoring
16219 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
16220 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
16221 like this in your score file:
16225 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
16230 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
16231 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
16234 @node Global Score Files
16235 @section Global Score Files
16236 @cindex global score files
16238 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
16239 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
16240 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
16242 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
16243 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
16244 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
16246 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
16247 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
16248 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
16249 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
16250 files are applicable to which group.
16252 Say you want to use the score file
16253 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
16254 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory:
16257 (setq gnus-global-score-files
16258 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
16259 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
16262 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
16263 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
16264 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
16265 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
16266 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
16268 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
16269 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
16271 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
16272 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
16273 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
16274 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
16275 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
16276 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
16278 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
16284 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
16286 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
16288 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
16290 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
16291 lowered out of existence.
16293 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
16294 articles completely.
16297 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
16298 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
16299 old articles for a long time.
16302 ... I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
16303 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
16304 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
16305 holding our breath yet?
16309 @section Kill Files
16312 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
16313 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
16314 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
16316 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
16317 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
16318 files into score files.
16320 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
16321 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
16322 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
16323 that isn't a very good idea.
16325 Normal kill files look like this:
16328 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16329 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
16333 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
16334 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
16336 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
16337 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
16340 Two summary functions for editing a GNUS kill file:
16345 @kindex M-k (Summary)
16346 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
16347 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
16350 @kindex M-K (Summary)
16351 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
16352 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
16355 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
16360 @kindex M-k (Group)
16361 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
16362 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
16365 @kindex M-K (Group)
16366 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
16367 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
16370 Kill file variables:
16373 @item gnus-kill-file-name
16374 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
16375 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
16376 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
16377 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
16378 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
16379 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
16381 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
16382 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
16383 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
16384 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
16387 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
16388 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
16389 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
16390 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
16391 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
16392 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
16393 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
16394 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
16395 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
16397 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
16398 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
16399 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
16404 @node Converting Kill Files
16405 @section Converting Kill Files
16407 @cindex converting kill files
16409 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
16410 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
16411 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
16414 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
16415 You can fetch it from
16416 @file{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
16418 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
16419 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
16420 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
16428 GroupLens is a collaborative filtering system that helps you work
16429 together with other people to find the quality news articles out of the
16430 huge volume of news articles generated every day.
16432 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
16433 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
16434 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
16435 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
16436 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
16437 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
16438 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
16439 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
16443 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
16444 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
16445 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
16446 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
16450 @node Using GroupLens
16451 @subsection Using GroupLens
16453 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local Better
16455 @samp{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html} is the only
16456 better bit in town at the moment.
16458 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
16462 @item gnus-use-grouplens
16463 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
16464 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
16465 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
16467 @item grouplens-pseudonym
16468 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
16469 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
16470 with the Better Bit Bureau.
16472 @item grouplens-newsgroups
16473 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
16474 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
16478 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
16479 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
16480 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
16481 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
16482 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
16483 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
16486 @node Rating Articles
16487 @subsection Rating Articles
16489 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
16490 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
16491 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
16492 yourself is, "on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
16495 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
16500 @kindex r (GroupLens)
16501 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
16502 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
16505 @kindex k (GroupLens)
16506 @findex grouplens-score-thread
16507 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
16508 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
16509 threads in rec.humor.
16513 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
16514 the score of the article you're reading.
16519 @kindex n (GroupLens)
16520 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
16521 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
16524 @kindex , (GroupLens)
16525 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
16526 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
16530 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
16531 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
16534 @node Displaying Predictions
16535 @subsection Displaying Predictions
16537 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
16538 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
16539 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
16540 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
16541 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
16543 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
16544 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
16545 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
16546 regular gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
16547 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
16548 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
16549 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
16550 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
16551 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
16552 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
16553 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
16554 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
16555 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
16557 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
16558 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
16559 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
16560 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
16562 The following are valid values for that variable.
16565 @item prediction-spot
16566 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
16569 @item confidence-interval
16570 A numeric confidence interval.
16572 @item prediction-bar
16573 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
16575 @item confidence-bar
16576 Numerical confidence.
16578 @item confidence-spot
16579 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
16581 @item prediction-num
16582 Plain-old numeric value.
16584 @item confidence-plus-minus
16585 Prediction +/- confidence.
16590 @node GroupLens Variables
16591 @subsection GroupLens Variables
16595 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
16596 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
16597 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
16598 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%)
16601 @item grouplens-bbb-host
16602 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
16605 @item grouplens-bbb-port
16606 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
16608 @item grouplens-score-offset
16609 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
16610 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
16613 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
16614 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
16615 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
16620 @node Advanced Scoring
16621 @section Advanced Scoring
16623 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
16624 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
16625 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
16626 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
16627 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
16629 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
16633 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
16634 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
16635 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
16639 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
16640 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
16642 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
16643 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
16644 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
16645 non-@code{nil} value.
16647 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
16648 operator, and various match operators.
16655 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
16656 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
16657 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
16662 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
16663 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
16664 then this operator will return @code{false}.
16669 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
16670 logical negation of the value of its argument.
16674 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
16675 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
16676 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
16677 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
16678 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
16679 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
16680 the ancestry you want to go.
16682 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
16683 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
16684 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
16685 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
16686 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
16689 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
16690 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
16692 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
16693 when he's talking about Gnus:
16697 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16698 ("subject" "Gnus"))
16704 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
16708 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16715 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
16716 really don't want to read what he's written:
16720 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16721 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
16725 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
16726 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
16727 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
16734 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
16735 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
16736 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
16737 ("body" "white.*socks"))
16741 The possibilities are endless.
16744 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
16745 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
16747 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
16748 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
16749 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
16750 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
16751 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
16752 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
16753 @samp{subject}) first.
16755 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
16756 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
16767 Then that means "score on the from header of the grandparent of the
16768 current article". An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
16774 ("subject" "Gnus")))
16781 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
16782 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
16787 @section Score Decays
16788 @cindex score decays
16791 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
16792 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
16793 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
16794 use them in any sensible way.
16796 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
16797 @findex gnus-decay-score
16798 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
16799 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
16800 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
16801 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
16802 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
16803 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
16804 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
16805 definition of that function:
16808 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
16810 This is done according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
16811 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
16814 (* (if (< score 0) 1 -1)
16816 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
16818 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
16821 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
16822 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
16823 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
16824 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
16828 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
16831 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
16834 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
16838 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
16839 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
16840 the new score, which should be an integer.
16842 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
16843 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
16850 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
16851 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
16852 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
16853 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
16854 * Windows Configuration:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
16855 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
16856 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
16857 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
16858 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
16859 * Buttons:: Get tendonitis in ten easy steps!
16860 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
16861 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
16862 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
16863 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
16864 * XEmacs Enhancements:: There are more pictures and stuff under XEmacs.
16865 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
16866 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
16867 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
16871 @node Process/Prefix
16872 @section Process/Prefix
16873 @cindex process/prefix convention
16875 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
16876 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
16878 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
16879 command to be performed on.
16883 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
16884 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
16885 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
16886 with the current one.
16888 @vindex transient-mark-mode
16889 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
16890 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
16892 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
16893 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
16896 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
16897 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
16899 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
16902 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
16903 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
16904 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
16905 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
16907 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
16908 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
16909 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
16910 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
16911 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
16912 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
16913 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
16914 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
16916 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
16917 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
16918 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
16919 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
16920 expirable, you could say `M P b M-& E'.
16924 @section Interactive
16925 @cindex interaction
16929 @item gnus-novice-user
16930 @vindex gnus-novice-user
16931 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
16932 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
16933 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
16934 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
16937 @item gnus-expert-user
16938 @vindex gnus-expert-user
16939 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
16940 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
16941 matter how strange.
16943 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
16944 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
16945 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
16946 is @code{t} by default.
16948 @item gnus-interactive-exit
16949 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
16950 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
16955 @node Symbolic Prefixes
16956 @section Symbolic Prefixes
16957 @cindex symbolic prefixes
16959 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
16960 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
16961 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
16962 rule of 900 to the current article.
16964 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
16965 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
16966 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
16967 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
16968 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
16969 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
16970 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
16972 @kindex M-i (Summary)
16973 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
16974 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
16975 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
16976 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
16977 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a M-C-u} means ``feed the @kbd{M-C-u}
16978 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b M-C-u} means
16979 ``feed the @kbd{M-C-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
16980 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
16982 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
16983 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
16984 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
16986 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
16990 @node Formatting Variables
16991 @section Formatting Variables
16992 @cindex formatting variables
16994 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
16995 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
16996 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
16997 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
16998 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
17001 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
17002 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
17003 lots of percentages everywhere.
17006 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
17007 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
17008 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
17009 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
17010 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
17013 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
17014 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
17015 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
17016 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
17017 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
17018 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
17019 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
17020 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
17022 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
17023 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
17025 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
17026 @findex gnus-update-format
17027 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
17028 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
17029 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
17030 examine the resulting lisp code to be run to generate the line.
17034 @node Formatting Basics
17035 @subsection Formatting Basics
17037 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
17038 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
17039 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
17041 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
17042 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
17043 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
17044 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
17045 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
17048 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
17049 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
17050 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
17051 less than 4 characters wide.
17054 @node Mode Line Formatting
17055 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
17057 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
17058 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
17059 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
17060 with the following two differences:
17065 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
17068 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
17069 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
17070 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
17071 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
17072 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
17073 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
17074 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
17079 @node Advanced Formatting
17080 @subsection Advanced Formatting
17082 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
17083 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
17084 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
17085 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
17087 These are the valid modifiers:
17092 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
17096 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
17101 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
17104 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
17109 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
17112 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
17115 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
17118 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
17122 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
17123 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
17124 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
17125 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
17126 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
17127 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
17128 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
17130 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
17131 last operation, padding.
17133 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
17134 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
17135 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
17136 @xref{Compilation}.
17139 @node User-Defined Specs
17140 @subsection User-Defined Specs
17142 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
17143 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
17144 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
17145 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
17146 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
17147 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
17148 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
17149 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
17150 should protect against that.
17152 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
17153 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
17154 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
17155 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
17159 @node Formatting Fonts
17160 @subsection Formatting Fonts
17162 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
17163 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
17164 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
17165 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
17168 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
17169 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
17170 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
17171 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
17172 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
17173 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
17175 Text inside the @samp{%<} and @samp{%>} specifiers will get the special
17176 @code{balloon-help} property set to @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you
17177 say @samp{%1<}, you'll get @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The
17178 @code{gnus-balloon-face-*} variables should be either strings or symbols
17179 naming functions that return a string. Under @code{balloon-help-mode},
17180 when the mouse passes over text with this property set, a balloon window
17181 will appear and display the string. Please refer to the doc string of
17182 @code{balloon-help-mode} for more information on this.
17184 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
17187 ;; Create three face types.
17188 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
17189 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
17191 ;; We want the article count to be in
17192 ;; a bold and green face. So we create
17193 ;; a new face called `my-green-bold'.
17194 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
17196 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
17197 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
17199 ;; Set the new & fancy format.
17200 (setq gnus-group-line-format
17201 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
17204 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
17205 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
17207 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
17208 mode-line variables.
17211 @node Windows Configuration
17212 @section Windows Configuration
17213 @cindex windows configuration
17215 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
17217 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
17218 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
17219 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
17220 @code{t} by default.
17222 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
17223 glitches. Use at your own peril.
17225 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
17226 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
17227 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
17230 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
17231 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
17232 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
17236 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
17237 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
17238 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
17239 possible names is listed below.
17241 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
17242 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
17245 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
17249 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
17250 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
17251 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
17252 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
17253 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
17254 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
17255 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
17256 size spec per split.
17258 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
17259 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
17260 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
17261 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
17262 present) gets focus.
17264 Here's a more complicated example:
17267 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
17268 (summary 0.25 point)
17269 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
17273 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
17274 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
17275 occupy, not a percentage.
17277 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
17278 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
17279 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
17280 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
17281 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
17284 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
17287 (article (horizontal 1.0
17292 (summary 0.25 point)
17297 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
17298 @code{horizontal} thingie?
17300 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
17301 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
17302 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
17303 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
17304 the screen is to be given to this strip.
17306 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
17307 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
17308 lines from the splits.
17310 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
17314 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
17315 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
17316 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
17317 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
17318 buffer = "(" buffer-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
17319 size = number | frame-params
17320 buffer-name = group | article | summary ...
17323 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
17324 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
17325 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
17326 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
17328 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
17329 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
17330 @cindex window height
17331 @cindex window width
17332 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
17333 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
17334 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
17335 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
17336 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
17337 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
17339 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
17340 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
17341 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
17342 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
17344 @findex gnus-configure-frame
17345 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
17346 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
17347 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
17348 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
17349 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
17350 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
17351 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
17352 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
17353 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
17354 configuration list.
17357 (gnus-configure-frame
17361 (article 0.3 point))
17369 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
17370 @code{frame} split:
17373 (gnus-configure-frame
17376 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
17378 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
17379 (user-position . t)
17380 (left . -1) (top . 1))
17385 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
17386 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
17387 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
17388 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
17389 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
17390 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
17391 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
17392 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
17394 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
17395 be found in its default value.
17397 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
17398 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
17399 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
17403 (message (horizontal 1.0
17404 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
17406 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
17411 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
17412 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
17413 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
17416 (message (frame 1.0
17417 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
17418 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
17419 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
17420 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
17421 (name . "Message"))
17422 (message 1.0 point))))
17425 @findex gnus-add-configuration
17426 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
17427 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
17428 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
17429 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
17432 (gnus-add-configuration
17433 '(article (vertical 1.0
17435 (summary .25 point)
17439 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
17440 @file{.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
17441 Gnus has been loaded.
17443 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
17444 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
17445 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
17446 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
17447 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
17449 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
17450 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
17451 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
17454 @subsection Example Window Configurations
17458 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
17459 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
17474 (gnus-add-configuration
17477 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
17479 (summary 0.16 point)
17482 (gnus-add-configuration
17485 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
17486 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
17492 @node Faces and Fonts
17493 @section Faces and Fonts
17498 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
17499 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
17500 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
17505 @section Compilation
17506 @cindex compilation
17507 @cindex byte-compilation
17509 @findex gnus-compile
17511 Remember all those line format specification variables?
17512 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
17513 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
17514 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
17515 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
17516 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
17519 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
17520 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
17521 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
17522 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
17523 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
17524 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
17525 them into the @code{.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
17529 @section Mode Lines
17532 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
17533 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
17534 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
17535 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
17536 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
17537 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
17538 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
17541 @cindex display-time
17543 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
17544 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
17545 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
17546 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
17547 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
17548 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
17549 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
17550 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
17553 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
17555 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
17556 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
17558 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
17559 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
17560 (length display-time-string)))))
17563 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
17564 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
17565 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
17566 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
17567 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
17570 @node Highlighting and Menus
17571 @section Highlighting and Menus
17573 @cindex highlighting
17576 @vindex gnus-visual
17577 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
17578 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
17579 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
17582 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
17583 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
17586 @item group-highlight
17587 Do highlights in the group buffer.
17588 @item summary-highlight
17589 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
17590 @item article-highlight
17591 Do highlights in the article buffer.
17593 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
17595 Create menus in the group buffer.
17597 Create menus in the summary buffers.
17599 Create menus in the article buffer.
17601 Create menus in the browse buffer.
17603 Create menus in the server buffer.
17605 Create menus in the score buffers.
17607 Create menus in all buffers.
17610 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
17611 buffers, you could say something like:
17614 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
17617 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
17620 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
17623 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
17624 in all Gnus buffers.
17626 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
17629 @item gnus-mouse-face
17630 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
17631 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
17632 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
17636 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
17640 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
17641 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
17642 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
17644 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
17645 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
17646 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
17648 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
17649 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
17650 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
17652 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
17653 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
17654 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
17656 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
17657 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
17658 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
17660 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
17661 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
17662 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
17673 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
17674 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
17675 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
17676 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
17677 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
17681 @vindex gnus-carpal
17682 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
17683 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
17684 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
17689 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
17690 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
17691 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
17693 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
17694 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
17695 Face used on buttons.
17697 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
17698 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
17699 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
17701 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
17702 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
17703 Buttons in the group buffer.
17705 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
17706 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
17707 Buttons in the summary buffer.
17709 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
17710 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
17711 Buttons in the server buffer.
17713 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
17714 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
17715 Buttons in the browse buffer.
17718 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
17719 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
17720 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
17728 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
17729 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
17730 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
17731 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
17732 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
17734 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
17735 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
17736 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
17738 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
17739 been idle for thirty minutes:
17742 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
17745 Here's a handler that scans for PGP headers every hour when Emacs is
17749 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
17752 This @var{time} parameter and than @var{idle} parameter work together
17753 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
17754 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
17756 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
17757 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
17758 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
17759 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
17761 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
17762 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
17763 @var{idle} minutes.
17765 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
17766 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
17769 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
17770 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
17771 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
17773 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
17774 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
17775 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
17776 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
17778 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
17779 your @file{.gnus} file:
17781 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
17783 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
17786 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
17787 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
17788 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
17789 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
17790 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
17791 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
17792 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
17793 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
17794 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
17795 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
17796 @file{.gnus} if you want those abilities.
17798 @findex gnus-demon-init
17799 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
17800 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
17801 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
17802 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
17803 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
17805 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
17806 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
17807 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
17816 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
17817 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
17819 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
17820 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
17821 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
17822 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
17825 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
17826 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
17827 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
17828 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
17830 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
17831 this will make spam disappear.
17833 There are some variables to customize, of course:
17836 @item gnus-use-nocem
17837 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
17838 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
17841 @item gnus-nocem-groups
17842 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
17843 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
17844 default is @code{("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
17845 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")}.
17847 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
17848 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
17849 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
17850 people you want to listen to. The default is @code{("Automoose-1"
17851 "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo"
17852 "hweede@@snafu.de")}; fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
17854 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at
17855 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
17857 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
17858 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
17859 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
17860 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
17861 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
17862 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
17863 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
17864 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
17865 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
17866 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
17868 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
17869 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
17872 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
17875 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
17876 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
17879 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
17882 The specs are applied left-to-right.
17885 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
17886 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
17888 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
17889 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
17890 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
17891 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
17893 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
17894 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
17897 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
17899 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
17907 This might be dangerous, though.
17909 @item gnus-nocem-directory
17910 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
17911 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is
17912 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
17914 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
17915 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
17916 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
17917 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
17918 might then see old spam.
17920 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
17921 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
17922 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
17923 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
17924 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
17927 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
17928 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
17929 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
17930 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
17934 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
17935 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
17936 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
17937 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
17944 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
17945 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
17946 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
17948 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
17949 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
17950 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
17951 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
17952 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
17953 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
17954 @code{undo} function.
17956 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
17957 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
17958 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
17959 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
17960 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
17961 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
17962 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
17963 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
17964 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
17965 never be totally undoable.
17967 @findex gnus-undo-mode
17968 @vindex gnus-use-undo
17970 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
17971 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
17972 default. The @kbd{M-C-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo} command
17973 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
17978 @section Moderation
17981 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
17982 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
17983 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
17986 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
17990 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
17993 in your @file{.gnus.el} file.
17995 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
18000 You split your incoming mail by matching on
18001 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
18002 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
18005 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
18006 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
18009 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
18010 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
18014 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
18017 (setq gnus-moderated-list
18018 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
18022 @node XEmacs Enhancements
18023 @section XEmacs Enhancements
18026 XEmacs is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has taken
18030 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what your reading.
18031 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
18032 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
18033 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
18046 So... You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
18047 good way to do so. Its also a great way to impress people staring
18048 over your shoulder as you read news.
18051 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
18052 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
18053 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
18054 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
18055 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
18060 @subsubsection Picon Basics
18062 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
18071 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
18072 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
18073 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
18074 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
18075 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
18076 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
18077 @code{GIF} formats.
18080 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18081 If you have a permanent connection to the Internet you can use Steve
18082 Kinzler's Picons Search engine by setting
18083 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} to the string @*
18084 @file{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/search.html}.
18086 @vindex gnus-picons-database
18087 Otherwise you need a local copy of his database. For instructions on
18088 obtaining and installing the picons databases, point your Web browser at @*
18089 @file{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}. Gnus expects
18090 picons to be installed into a location pointed to by
18091 @code{gnus-picons-database}.
18094 @node Picon Requirements
18095 @subsubsection Picon Requirements
18097 To have Gnus display Picons for you, you must be running XEmacs
18098 19.13 or greater since all other versions of Emacs aren't yet able to
18101 Additionally, you must have @code{x} support compiled into XEmacs. To
18102 display color picons which are much nicer than the black & white one,
18103 you also need one of @code{xpm} or @code{gif} compiled into XEmacs.
18105 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18106 If you want to display faces from @code{X-Face} headers, you should have
18107 the @code{xface} support compiled into XEmacs. Otherwise you must have
18108 the @code{netpbm} utilities installed, or munge the
18109 @code{gnus-picons-convert-x-face} variable to use something else.
18113 @subsubsection Easy Picons
18115 To enable displaying picons, simply put the following line in your
18116 @file{~/.gnus} file and start Gnus.
18119 (setq gnus-use-picons t)
18120 (setq gnus-treat-display-picons t)
18123 and make sure @code{gnus-picons-database} points to the directory
18124 containing the Picons databases.
18126 Alternatively if you want to use the web piconsearch engine add this:
18129 (setq gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18130 "http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch")
18135 @subsubsection Hard Picons
18143 Gnus can display picons for you as you enter and leave groups and
18144 articles. It knows how to interact with three sections of the picons
18145 database. Namely, it can display the picons newsgroup pictures,
18146 author's face picture(s), and the authors domain. To enable this
18147 feature, you need to select where to get the picons from, and where to
18152 @item gnus-picons-database
18153 @vindex gnus-picons-database
18154 The location of the picons database. Should point to a directory
18155 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
18156 subdirectories. This is only useful if
18157 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} is @code{nil}. Defaults to
18158 @file{/usr/local/faces/}.
18160 @item gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18161 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18162 The URL for the web picons search engine. The only currently known
18163 engine is @file{http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch}. To
18164 workaround network delays, icons will be fetched in the background. If
18165 this is @code{nil} 'the default), then picons are fetched from local
18166 database indicated by @code{gnus-picons-database}.
18168 @item gnus-picons-display-where
18169 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
18170 Where the picon images should be displayed. It is @code{picons} by
18171 default (which by default maps to the buffer @samp{*Picons*}). Other
18172 valid places could be @code{article}, @code{summary}, or
18173 @samp{*scratch*} for all I care. Just make sure that you've made the
18174 buffer visible using the standard Gnus window configuration
18175 routines---@pxref{Windows Configuration}.
18177 @item gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
18178 @vindex gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
18179 Groups that are matched by this regexp won't have their group icons
18184 Note: If you set @code{gnus-use-picons} to @code{t}, it will set up your
18185 window configuration for you to include the @code{picons} buffer.
18187 Now that you've made those decision, you need to add the following
18188 functions to the appropriate hooks so these pictures will get displayed
18191 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
18193 @item gnus-article-display-picons
18194 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
18195 Looks up and displays the picons for the author and the author's domain
18196 in the @code{gnus-picons-display-where} buffer.
18198 @item gnus-picons-article-display-x-face
18199 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
18200 Decodes and displays the X-Face header if present.
18206 @node Picon Useless Configuration
18207 @subsubsection Picon Useless Configuration
18215 The following variables offer further control over how things are
18216 done, where things are located, and other useless stuff you really
18217 don't need to worry about.
18221 @item gnus-picons-news-directories
18222 @vindex gnus-picons-news-directories
18223 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
18224 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
18226 @item gnus-picons-user-directories
18227 @vindex gnus-picons-user-directories
18228 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for user
18229 faces. @code{("local" "users" "usenix" "misc")} is the default.
18231 @item gnus-picons-domain-directories
18232 @vindex gnus-picons-domain-directories
18233 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
18234 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
18235 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
18237 @item gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18238 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18239 If you don't have @code{xface} support builtin XEmacs, this is the
18240 command to use to convert the @code{X-Face} header to an X bitmap
18241 (@code{xbm}). Defaults to @code{(format "@{ echo '/* Width=48,
18242 Height=48 */'; uncompface; @} | icontopbm | pbmtoxbm > %s"
18243 gnus-picons-x-face-file-name)}
18245 @item gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
18246 @vindex gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
18247 Names a temporary file to store the @code{X-Face} bitmap in. Defaults
18248 to @code{(format "/tmp/picon-xface.%s.xbm" (user-login-name))}.
18250 @item gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
18251 @vindex gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
18252 If you have set @code{gnus-picons-display-where} to @code{picons}, your
18253 XEmacs frame will become really cluttered. To alleviate this a bit you
18254 can set @code{gnus-picons-has-modeline-p} to @code{nil}; this will
18255 remove the mode line from the Picons buffer. This is only useful if
18256 @code{gnus-picons-display-where} is @code{picons}.
18258 @item gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
18259 @vindex gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
18260 If non-nil, display the article buffer before computing the picons.
18261 Defaults to @code{nil}.
18263 @item gnus-picons-display-as-address
18264 @vindex gnus-picons-display-as-address
18265 If @code{t} display textual email addresses along with pictures.
18266 Defaults to @code{t}.
18268 @item gnus-picons-file-suffixes
18269 @vindex gnus-picons-file-suffixes
18270 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
18271 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not builtin your XEmacs.
18273 @item gnus-picons-setup-hook
18274 @vindex gnus-picons-setup-hook
18275 Hook run in the picon buffer, if that is displayed.
18277 @item gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
18278 @vindex gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
18279 Whether to move point to first empty line when displaying picons. This
18280 has only an effect if `gnus-picons-display-where' has value `article'.
18282 If @code{nil}, display the picons in the @code{From} and
18283 @code{Newsgroups} lines. This is the defailt.
18285 @item gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
18286 @vindex gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
18287 Whether to clear the picons cache when exiting gnus. Gnus caches every
18288 picons it finds while it is running. This saves some time in the search
18289 process but eats some memory. If this variable is set to @code{nil},
18290 Gnus will never clear the cache itself; you will have to manually call
18291 @code{gnus-picons-clear-cache} to clear it. Otherwise the cache will be
18292 cleared every time you exit Gnus. Defaults to @code{t}.
18303 @subsection Smileys
18308 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/BigFace.ps,height=20cm}}
18313 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
18314 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
18316 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
18317 @file{.gnus.el} file:
18320 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
18323 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{:-=}, @samp{:-(} and
18324 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
18325 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
18326 text and maps that to file names.
18328 @vindex smiley-nosey-regexp-alist
18329 @vindex smiley-deformed-regexp-alist
18330 Smiley supplies two example conversion alists by default:
18331 @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist} (which matches @samp{:)}, @samp{:(}
18332 and so on), and @code{smiley-nosey-regexp-alist} (which matches
18333 @samp{:-)}, @samp{:-(} and so on).
18335 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist} variable,
18336 which defaults to the value of @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist}.
18338 The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched; the second
18339 element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by the picture;
18340 and the third element is the name of the file to be displayed.
18342 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
18343 files, as well as the color to be used and stuff:
18347 @item smiley-data-directory
18348 @vindex smiley-data-directory
18349 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
18351 @item smiley-flesh-color
18352 @vindex smiley-flesh-color
18353 Skin color. The default is @samp{yellow}, which is really racist.
18355 @item smiley-features-color
18356 @vindex smiley-features-color
18357 Color of the features of the face. The default is @samp{black}.
18359 @item smiley-tongue-color
18360 @vindex smiley-tongue-color
18361 Color of the tongue. The default is @samp{red}.
18363 @item smiley-circle-color
18364 @vindex smiley-circle-color
18365 Color of the circle around the face. The default is @samp{black}.
18367 @item smiley-mouse-face
18368 @vindex smiley-mouse-face
18369 Face used for mouse highlighting over the smiley face.
18375 @subsection Toolbar
18385 @item gnus-use-toolbar
18386 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
18387 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
18388 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
18389 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
18391 @item gnus-group-toolbar
18392 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
18393 The toolbar in the group buffer.
18395 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
18396 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
18397 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
18399 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
18400 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
18401 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
18407 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
18410 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
18411 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
18412 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
18413 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
18414 unusual directory structure.
18416 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
18417 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
18418 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
18419 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
18421 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
18422 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
18423 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
18424 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
18425 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
18426 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
18428 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
18429 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
18430 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
18444 @node Fuzzy Matching
18445 @section Fuzzy Matching
18446 @cindex fuzzy matching
18448 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
18449 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
18451 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
18452 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
18453 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
18455 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
18456 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
18457 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
18458 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
18459 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
18462 @node Thwarting Email Spam
18463 @section Thwarting Email Spam
18467 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
18469 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
18470 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
18471 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
18472 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
18473 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
18474 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
18475 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
18476 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
18479 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
18480 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
18481 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
18482 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
18483 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
18484 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
18488 The way to deal with this is having Gnus split out all spam into a
18489 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
18491 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
18492 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
18493 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
18494 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
18495 sysadm whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
18496 part of the mail address.)
18499 (setq message-default-news-headers
18500 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
18503 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
18504 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
18509 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
18510 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
18511 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
18517 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
18518 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
18519 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
18520 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
18522 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @code{smtp} server
18523 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
18524 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
18525 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
18526 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
18527 your fancy split rule in this way:
18532 (to "larsi" "misc")
18536 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
18537 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
18538 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
18539 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
18540 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
18542 If you are also a lazy net citizen, you will probably prefer complaining
18543 automatically with the @file{gnus-junk.el} package, available FOR FREE
18544 at @* @file{<URL:http://stud2.tuwien.ac.at/~e9426626/gnus-junk.html>}.
18545 Since most e-mail spam is sent automatically, this may reconcile the
18546 cosmic balance somewhat.
18548 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
18549 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
18550 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
18551 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
18554 @node Various Various
18555 @section Various Various
18561 @item gnus-home-directory
18562 All Gnus path variables will be initialized from this variable, which
18563 defaults to @file{~/}.
18565 @item gnus-directory
18566 @vindex gnus-directory
18567 Most Gnus storage path variables will be initialized from this variable,
18568 which defaults to the @samp{SAVEDIR} environment variable, or
18569 @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
18571 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{.gnus.el} file is read.
18572 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
18573 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
18574 @file{.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
18576 @item gnus-default-directory
18577 @vindex gnus-default-directory
18578 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
18579 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
18580 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
18581 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
18582 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
18583 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
18586 @vindex gnus-verbose
18587 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
18588 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
18589 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
18590 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
18591 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
18593 @item gnus-verbose-backends
18594 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
18595 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
18596 to the Gnus backends instead of Gnus proper.
18598 @item nnheader-max-head-length
18599 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
18600 When the backends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
18601 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
18602 the absolute max length the backends will try to read before giving up
18603 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
18604 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
18605 @code{t}, the backends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
18606 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
18607 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
18609 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
18610 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
18611 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
18612 read when doing the operation described above.
18614 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18615 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18617 @cindex invalid characters in file names
18618 @cindex characters in file names
18619 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
18620 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
18621 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
18624 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18628 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
18629 Windows (phooey) systems.
18631 @item gnus-hidden-properties
18632 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
18633 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
18634 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
18635 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
18637 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
18638 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
18639 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
18640 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
18641 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
18643 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
18644 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
18645 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
18647 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
18648 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
18650 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
18651 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
18652 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
18653 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
18656 IMAP users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
18665 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
18666 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
18668 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
18670 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
18676 Not because of victories @*
18679 but for the common sunshine,@*
18681 the largess of the spring.
18685 but for the day's work done@*
18686 as well as I was able;@*
18687 not for a seat upon the dais@*
18688 but at the common table.@*
18693 @chapter Appendices
18696 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
18697 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
18698 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
18699 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
18700 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
18701 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
18702 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
18703 * Frequently Asked Questions:: A question-and-answer session.
18711 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
18712 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
18714 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
18715 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
18716 @file{http://quimby.gnus.org/~larsi/}. This is also the primary
18717 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
18718 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
18720 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
18721 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
18722 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
18723 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
18724 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
18725 appropriate name, don't you think?)
18727 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
18728 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
18729 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
18730 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
18733 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
18734 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
18735 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
18736 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
18737 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
18738 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
18739 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
18740 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
18741 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
18742 * Newest Features:: Features so new that they haven't been written yet.
18746 @node Gnus Versions
18747 @subsection Gnus Versions
18748 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
18750 @cindex September Gnus
18751 @cindex Quassia Gnus
18753 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
18754 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
18755 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
18757 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
18758 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
18760 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
18761 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
18763 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
18764 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
18766 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
18767 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
18770 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
18771 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'' --
18772 don't panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away.
18773 Slowly. Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're
18774 out of its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up
18778 @node Other Gnus Versions
18779 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
18782 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
18783 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
18784 Japan. It's based on a library called @sc{semi}, which provides
18785 @sc{mime} capabilities.
18787 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
18788 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
18789 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
18790 @sc{mime} and multilingualization things, especially important for
18797 What's the point of Gnus?
18799 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
18800 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
18801 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
18802 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
18803 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
18804 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
18805 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
18806 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
18807 keep track of millions of people who post?
18809 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
18810 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
18811 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
18812 to separate the newsreader from the backends, Gnus now offers a simple
18813 interface for anybody who wants to write new backends for fetching mail
18814 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
18815 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
18816 every one of you to explore and invent.
18818 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
18819 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
18822 @node Compatibility
18823 @subsection Compatibility
18825 @cindex compatibility
18826 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
18827 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
18828 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
18833 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
18837 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
18840 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
18843 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
18844 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
18845 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
18846 important variables have their values copied into their global
18847 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
18848 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
18850 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
18851 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
18852 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
18853 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
18854 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
18858 @cindex highlighting
18859 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
18860 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
18861 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
18862 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
18863 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
18864 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
18867 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
18868 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
18869 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
18870 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
18872 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
18873 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
18874 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
18875 to stop doing it the old way.
18877 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
18879 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
18881 @cindex reporting bugs
18883 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
18884 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
18885 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
18887 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
18888 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
18889 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
18890 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
18895 @subsection Conformity
18897 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
18898 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
18905 There are no known breaches of this standard.
18909 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
18911 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
18912 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
18913 We do have some breaches to this one.
18919 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
18920 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
18921 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
18922 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
18923 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
18928 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
18929 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
18930 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
18931 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
18935 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
18936 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
18941 @subsection Emacsen
18947 Gnus should work on :
18955 XEmacs 20.4 and up.
18959 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
18960 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
18963 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
18964 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
18965 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
18969 @node Gnus Development
18970 @subsection Gnus Development
18972 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
18973 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
18974 propose changes and new features, post patches and new backends. This
18975 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
18976 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
18977 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
18978 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
18979 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
18981 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
18982 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
18983 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
18984 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
18985 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
18988 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
18989 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
18990 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
18991 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
18992 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
18994 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
18995 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
18996 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
18997 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
18998 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
18999 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
19000 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
19001 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
19002 usually keep up with these rapid changes, whille people on the newsgroup
19003 can't be assumed to do so.
19008 @subsection Contributors
19009 @cindex contributors
19011 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
19012 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
19013 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
19014 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
19015 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
19016 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
19017 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
19018 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
19019 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
19020 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
19022 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for... oops,
19028 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
19031 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
19032 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @sc{mime} and
19033 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
19034 functionality and stuff.
19037 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
19038 well as numerous other things).
19041 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
19044 Justin Sheehy--the FAQ maintainer.
19047 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
19050 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
19051 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
19054 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
19057 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
19058 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
19061 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
19064 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
19067 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
19070 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
19073 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
19074 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
19077 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
19080 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
19083 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
19086 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
19090 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
19093 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
19096 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
19099 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
19100 well as autoconf support.
19104 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
19105 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
19107 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
19116 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
19120 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
19130 Alexei V. Barantsev,
19145 Massimo Campostrini,
19150 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
19151 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
19155 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
19158 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
19164 Michael Welsh Duggan,
19169 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
19173 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
19181 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
19183 Michelangelo Grigni,
19187 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
19189 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c ?
19191 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
19198 François Felix Ingrand,
19199 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c ?
19200 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
19202 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
19213 Peter Skov Knudsen,
19214 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
19216 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
19217 Thor Kristoffersen,
19220 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
19238 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
19239 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
19246 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
19251 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
19255 John McClary Prevost,
19261 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
19266 Christian von Roques,
19269 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
19276 Philippe Schnoebelen,
19278 Randal L. Schwartz,
19292 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
19297 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
19313 Katsumi Yamaoka @c Yamaoka
19318 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
19319 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
19320 (550kB and counting).
19322 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
19325 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
19326 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
19330 @subsection New Features
19331 @cindex new features
19334 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
19335 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.3/5.3.
19336 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
19337 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
19340 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
19341 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
19342 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
19346 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
19348 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
19353 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
19354 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
19357 Local spool and several @sc{nntp} servers can be used at once
19358 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
19361 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
19364 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
19365 All the mail backends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
19366 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
19369 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
19370 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
19371 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
19372 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
19375 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
19376 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19379 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
19380 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
19381 (@pxref{The Active File}).
19384 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
19385 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
19388 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
19389 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
19390 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
19393 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
19394 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
19395 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
19398 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{.gnus}) to avoid cluttering up
19399 the @file{.emacs} file.
19402 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
19403 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19406 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
19407 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
19410 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
19411 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19414 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
19415 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
19418 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
19419 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
19422 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
19425 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
19426 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
19429 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
19430 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
19433 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
19434 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
19437 Gnus can fetch FAQs and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
19440 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
19441 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
19444 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
19448 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
19452 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
19453 configuration (@pxref{Windows Configuration}).
19456 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
19462 @node September Gnus
19463 @subsubsection September Gnus
19467 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/september.ps,height=20cm}}
19471 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
19476 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
19477 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
19481 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
19482 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
19486 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
19490 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
19491 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
19494 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
19498 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
19501 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
19504 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
19507 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
19511 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
19512 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
19515 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
19519 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
19523 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
19527 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
19531 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
19534 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
19535 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
19538 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
19542 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
19543 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
19546 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
19549 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
19550 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
19551 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
19554 Gnus has a new backend (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
19558 The Gnus cache is much faster.
19561 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
19565 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
19566 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
19569 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
19570 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
19573 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
19574 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
19577 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
19578 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
19579 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
19582 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
19583 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
19586 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
19589 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
19592 All mail backends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
19595 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
19598 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
19599 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
19602 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Windows
19606 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
19609 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}}
19614 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
19617 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
19621 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19624 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
19628 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
19631 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
19634 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
19635 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
19638 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
19639 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
19643 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
19644 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
19647 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
19651 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
19652 buffer to allow easier treatment.
19655 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
19658 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
19662 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
19666 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
19667 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
19670 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
19674 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
19675 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
19678 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
19679 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
19682 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
19686 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
19689 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
19692 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
19698 @subsubsection Red Gnus
19700 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
19704 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/red.ps,height=20cm}}
19711 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
19714 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
19715 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
19718 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
19719 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
19723 Article washing status can be displayed in the
19724 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
19727 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
19730 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
19731 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
19734 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
19738 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
19739 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
19743 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
19744 Server Internals}).
19747 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
19751 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
19754 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
19755 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
19758 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
19759 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
19760 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
19763 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
19764 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
19767 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
19768 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
19771 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{M-C-_}
19775 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
19776 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
19779 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
19780 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
19783 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
19787 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
19790 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
19794 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
19795 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
19798 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
19799 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
19802 A new command for reading collections of documents
19803 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{M-C-d}
19804 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
19807 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
19811 A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post even when the @sc{nntp}
19812 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
19815 A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
19816 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
19817 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
19820 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
19821 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
19825 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
19829 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
19833 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}}
19838 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
19842 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
19846 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
19847 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
19850 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
19856 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
19858 New features in Gnus 5.6:
19863 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
19864 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See
19865 @pxref{Gnus Unplugged} for the full story.
19868 The @code{nndraft} backend has returned, but works differently than
19869 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
19870 group, which is created automatically.
19873 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
19877 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
19880 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
19881 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
19884 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
19888 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
19891 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
19892 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
19895 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
19898 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
19899 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
19902 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
19903 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
19906 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
19907 control over simplification.
19910 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
19913 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
19917 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
19920 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
19923 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
19924 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
19925 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
19928 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
19929 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
19932 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
19936 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
19937 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
19940 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
19941 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @sc{nntp} servers.
19944 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
19948 A history of where mails have been split is available.
19951 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
19954 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
19955 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
19958 A new function for citing in Message has been
19959 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
19962 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
19965 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
19969 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
19970 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
19973 The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
19974 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
19977 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} backend.
19980 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
19985 @node Newest Features
19986 @subsection Newest Features
19989 Also known as the @dfn{todo list}. Sure to be implemented before the
19992 Be afraid. Be very afraid.
19994 (That a feature appears in this list doesn't necessarily mean that I've
19995 decided to actually implement it. It just means that I think it sounds
19998 (Yes, this is the actual, up-to-the-second todo list.)
20003 I would like the zombie-page to contain an URL to the source of the
20004 latest version of gnus or some explanation on where to find it.
20007 A way to continue editing the latest Message composition.
20010 http://www.sonicnet.com/feature/ari3/
20013 facep is not declared.
20016 Include a section in the manual on why the number of articles
20017 isn't the same in the group buffer and on the SPC prompt.
20020 Interacting with rmail fcc isn't easy.
20025 <URL:http://www.falch.no/people/pepper/DSSSL-Lite/archives/>
20026 <URL:http://www.eit.com/software/hypermail/hypermail.html>
20027 <URL:http://homer.ncm.com/>
20028 <URL:http://www.yahoo.com/Computers_and_Internet/Internet/World_Wide_Web/HTML_Converters/>
20029 http://www.uwsg.indiana.edu/hypermail/linux/kernel/9610/index.html
20030 <URL:http://union.ncsa.uiuc.edu/HyperNews/get/www/html/converters.html>
20031 http://www.miranova.com/gnus-list/
20036 @samp{^-- } is made into - in LaTeX.
20039 gnus-kill is much slower than it was in GNUS 4.1.3.
20042 when expunging articles on low score, the sparse nodes keep hanging on?
20044 starting the first time seems to hang Gnus on some systems. Does
20045 NEWGROUPS answer too fast?
20047 nndir doesn't read gzipped files.
20049 FAQ doesn't have an up node?
20051 when moving mail from a procmail spool to the crash-box,
20052 the crash-box is only appropriate to one specific group.
20054 `t' `t' makes X-Faces disappear.
20056 nnmh-be-safe means that crossposted articles will
20057 be marked as unread.
20059 Orphan score entries don't show on "V t" score trace
20061 when clearing out data, the cache data should also be reset.
20063 rewrite gnus-summary-limit-children to be non-recursive
20064 to avoid exceeding lisp nesting on huge groups.
20066 expunged articles are counted when computing scores.
20068 implement gnus-batch-brew-soup
20070 ticked articles aren't easy to read in pick mode -- `n' and
20071 stuff just skips past them. Read articles are the same.
20073 topics that contain just groups with ticked
20074 articles aren't displayed.
20076 nndoc should always allocate unique Message-IDs.
20078 If there are mail groups the first time you use Gnus, Gnus'll
20079 make the mail groups killed.
20081 no "no news is good news" when using topics.
20083 when doing crosspost marking, the cache has to be consulted
20084 and articles have to be removed.
20086 nnweb should fetch complete articles when they are split into several
20089 scoring on head immediate doesn't work.
20091 finding short score file names takes forever.
20093 canceling articles in foreign groups.
20095 nntp-open-rlogin no longer works.
20097 C-u C-x C-s (Summary) switches to the group buffer.
20099 move nnmail-split-history out to the backends.
20101 nnweb doesn't work properly.
20103 using a virtual server name as `gnus-select-method' doesn't work?
20105 when killing/yanking a group from one topic to another in a slave, the
20106 master will yank it first to one topic and then add it to another.
20110 warn user about `=' redirection of a group in the active file?
20112 take over the XEmacs menubar and offer a toggle between the XEmacs
20113 bar and the Gnus bar.
20116 push active file and NOV file parsing down into C code.
20117 `(canonize-message-id id)'
20118 `(mail-parent-message-id references n)'
20119 `(parse-news-nov-line &optional dependency-hashtb)'
20120 `(parse-news-nov-region beg end &optional dependency-hashtb fullp)'
20121 `(parse-news-active-region beg end hashtb)'
20126 nnml .overview directory with splits.
20130 postponed commands.
20132 the selected article show have its Subject displayed in its summary line.
20134 when entering groups, get the real number of unread articles from
20137 sort after gathering threads -- make false roots have the
20138 headers of the oldest orphan with a 0 article number?
20140 nndoc groups should inherit the score files of their parents? Also
20141 inherit copy prompts and save files.
20143 command to start up Gnus (if not running) and enter a mail mode buffer.
20145 allow editing the group description from the group buffer
20146 for backends that support that.
20148 gnus-hide,show-all-topics
20150 groups and sub-topics should be allowed to mingle inside each topic,
20151 and not just list all subtopics at the end.
20153 a command to remove all read articles that are not needed to connect
20154 threads -- `gnus-summary-limit-to-sparse-unread'?
20156 a variable to turn off limiting/cutting of threads in the tree buffer.
20158 a variable to limit how many files are uudecoded.
20160 add zombie groups to a special "New Groups" topic.
20162 server mode command: close/open all connections
20164 put a file date in gnus-score-alist and check whether the file
20165 has been changed before using it.
20167 on exit from a digest group, go to the next article in the parent group.
20169 hide (sub)threads with low score.
20171 when expiring, remove all marks from expired articles.
20173 gnus-summary-limit-to-body
20175 a regexp alist that says what level groups are to be subscribed
20176 on. Eg. -- `(("nnml:" . 1))'.
20178 easier interface to nnkiboze to create ephemeral groups that
20179 contain groups that match a regexp.
20181 allow newlines in <URL:> urls, but remove them before using
20184 If there is no From line, the mail backends should fudge one from the
20187 fuzzy simplifying should strip all non-alpha-numerical info
20188 from subject lines.
20190 gnus-soup-brew-soup-with-high-scores.
20192 nntp-ping-before-connect
20194 command to check whether NOV is evil. "list overview.fmt".
20196 when entering a group, Gnus should look through the score
20197 files very early for `local' atoms and set those local variables.
20199 message annotations.
20201 topics are always yanked before groups, and that's not good.
20203 (set-extent-property extent 'help-echo "String to display in minibuf")
20204 to display help in the minibuffer on buttons under XEmacs.
20206 allow group line format spec to say how many articles there
20211 `run-with-idle-timer' in gnus-demon.
20213 stop using invisible text properties and start using overlays instead
20215 C-c C-f C-e to add an Expires header.
20217 go from one group to the next; everything is expunged; go to the
20218 next group instead of going to the group buffer.
20220 gnus-renumber-cache -- to renumber the cache using "low" numbers.
20222 record topic changes in the dribble buffer.
20224 `nnfolder-generate-active-file' should look at the folders it
20225 finds and generate proper active ranges.
20227 nneething-look-in-files-for-article-heads variable to control
20228 whether nneething should sniff all files in the directories.
20230 gnus-fetch-article -- start Gnus, enter group, display article
20232 gnus-dont-move-articles-to-same-group variable when respooling.
20234 when messages are crossposted between several auto-expirable groups,
20235 articles aren't properly marked as expirable.
20237 nneething should allow deletion/moving.
20239 TAB on the last button should go to the first button.
20241 if the car of an element in `mail-split-methods' is a function,
20242 and the function returns non-nil, use that as the name of the group(s) to
20245 command for listing all score files that have been applied.
20247 a command in the article buffer to return to `summary' config.
20249 `gnus-always-post-using-current-server' -- variable to override
20250 `C-c C-c' when posting.
20252 nnmail-group-spool-alist -- says where each group should use
20255 when an article is crossposted to an auto-expirable group, the article
20256 should be marker as expirable.
20258 article mode command/menu for "send region as URL to browser".
20260 on errors, jump to info nodes that explain the error. For instance,
20261 on invalid From headers, or on error messages from the nntp server.
20263 when gathering threads, make the article that has no "Re: " the parent.
20264 Also consult Date headers.
20266 a token in splits to call shrink-window-if-larger-than-buffer
20268 `1 0 A M' to do matches on the active hashtb.
20270 duplicates -- command to remove Gnus-Warning header, use the read
20271 Message-ID, delete the "original".
20273 when replying to several messages at once, put the "other" message-ids
20274 into a See-Also header.
20276 support setext: URL:http://www.bsdi.com/setext/
20278 support ProleText: <URL:http://proletext.clari.net/prole/proletext.html>
20280 when browsing a foreign server, the groups that are already subscribed
20281 should be listed as such and not as "K".
20283 generate font names dynamically.
20285 score file mode auto-alist.
20287 allow nndoc to change/add/delete things from documents. Implement
20288 methods for each format for adding an article to the document.
20290 `gnus-fetch-old-headers' `all' value to incorporate
20291 absolutely all headers there is.
20293 function like `|', but concatenate all marked articles
20294 and pipe them to the process.
20296 cache the list of killed (or active) groups in a separate file. Update
20297 the file whenever we read the active file or the list
20298 of killed groups in the .eld file reaches a certain length.
20300 function for starting to edit a file to put into
20301 the current mail group.
20303 score-find-trace should display the total score of the article.
20305 "ghettozie" -- score on Xref header and nix it out after using it
20306 to avoid marking as read in other groups it has been crossposted to.
20308 look at procmail splitting. The backends should create
20309 the groups automatically if a spool file exists for that group.
20311 function for backends to register themselves with Gnus.
20313 when replying to several process-marked articles,
20314 have all the From end up in Cc headers? Variable to toggle.
20316 command to delete a crossposted mail article from all
20317 groups it has been mailed to.
20319 `B c' and `B m' should be crosspost aware.
20321 hide-pgp should also hide PGP public key blocks.
20323 Command in the group buffer to respool process-marked groups.
20325 `gnus-summary-find-matching' should accept
20326 pseudo-"headers" like "body", "head" and "all"
20328 When buttifying <URL: > things, all white space (including
20329 newlines) should be ignored.
20331 Process-marking all groups in a topic should process-mark
20332 groups in subtopics as well.
20334 Add non-native groups to the list of killed groups when killing them.
20336 nntp-suggest-kewl-config to probe the nntp server and suggest
20339 add edit and forward secondary marks.
20341 nnml shouldn't visit its .overview files.
20343 allow customizing sorting within gathered threads.
20345 `B q' shouldn't select the current article.
20347 nnmbox should support a newsgroups file for descriptions.
20349 allow fetching mail from several pop servers.
20351 Be able to specify whether the saving commands save the original
20352 or the formatted article.
20354 a command to reparent with the child process-marked (cf. `T ^'.).
20356 I think the possibility to send a password with nntp-open-rlogin
20357 should be a feature in Red Gnus.
20359 The `Z n' command should be possible to execute from a mouse click.
20361 more limiting functions -- date, etc.
20363 be able to limit on a random header; on body; using reverse matches.
20365 a group parameter (`absofucking-total-expiry') that will make Gnus expire
20366 even unread articles.
20368 a command to print the article buffer as postscript.
20370 variable to disable password fetching when opening by nntp-open-telnet.
20372 manual: more example servers -- nntp with rlogin, telnet
20374 checking for bogus groups should clean topic alists as well.
20376 canceling articles in foreign groups.
20378 article number in folded topics isn't properly updated by
20381 Movement in the group buffer to the next unread group should go to the
20382 next closed topic with unread messages if no group can be found.
20384 Extensive info pages generated on the fly with help everywhere --
20385 in the "*Gnus edit*" buffers, for instance.
20387 Topic movement commands -- like thread movement. Up, down, forward, next.
20389 a way to tick/mark as read Gcc'd articles.
20391 a way to say that all groups within a specific topic comes
20392 from a particular server? Hm.
20394 `gnus-article-fill-if-long-lines' -- a function to fill
20395 the article buffer if there are any looong lines there.
20397 `T h' should jump to the parent topic and fold it.
20399 a command to create an ephemeral nndoc group out of a file,
20400 and then splitting it/moving it to some other group/backend.
20402 a group parameter for nnkiboze groups that says that
20403 all kibozed articles should be entered into the cache.
20405 It should also probably be possible to delimit what
20406 `gnus-jog-cache' does -- for instance, work on just some groups, or on
20407 some levels, and entering just articles that have a score higher than
20410 nnfolder should append to the folder instead of re-writing
20411 the entire folder to disk when accepting new messages.
20413 allow all backends to do the proper thing with .gz files.
20415 a backend for reading collections of babyl files nnbabylfolder?
20417 a command for making the native groups into foreign groups.
20419 server mode command for clearing read marks from all groups
20422 when following up multiple articles, include all To, Cc, etc headers
20425 a command for deciding what the total score of the current
20426 thread is. Also a way to highlight based on this.
20428 command to show and edit group scores
20430 a gnus-tree-minimize-horizontal to minimize tree buffers
20433 command to generate nnml overview file for one group.
20435 `C-u C-u a' -- prompt for many crossposted groups.
20437 keep track of which mail groups have received new articles (in this session).
20438 Be able to generate a report and perhaps do some marking in the group
20441 gnus-build-sparse-threads to a number -- build only sparse threads
20442 that are of that length.
20444 have nnmh respect mh's unseen sequence in .mh_profile.
20446 cache the newsgroups descriptions locally.
20448 asynchronous posting under nntp.
20450 be able to control word adaptive scoring from the score files.
20452 a variable to make `C-c C-c' post using the "current" select method.
20454 `limit-exclude-low-scored-articles'.
20456 if `gnus-summary-show-thread' is a number, hide threads that have
20457 a score lower than this number.
20459 split newsgroup subscription variable up into "order" and "method".
20461 buttonize ange-ftp file names.
20463 a command to make a duplicate copy of the current article
20464 so that each copy can be edited separately.
20466 nnweb should allow fetching from the local nntp server.
20468 record the sorting done in the summary buffer so that
20469 it can be repeated when limiting/regenerating the buffer.
20471 nnml-generate-nov-databses should generate for
20474 when the user does commands in the group buffer, check
20475 the modification time of the .newsrc.eld file and use
20476 ask-user-about-supersession-threat. Also warn when trying
20477 to save .newsrc.eld and it has changed.
20479 M-g on a topic will display all groups with 0 articles in
20482 command to remove all topic stuff.
20484 allow exploding incoming digests when reading incoming mail
20485 and splitting the resulting digests.
20487 nnsoup shouldn't set the `message-' variables.
20489 command to nix out all nnoo state information.
20491 nnmail-process-alist that calls functions if group names
20492 matches an alist -- before saving.
20494 use buffer-invisibility-spec everywhere for hiding text.
20496 variable to activate each group before entering them
20497 to get the (new) number of articles. `gnus-activate-before-entering'.
20499 command to fetch a Message-ID from any buffer, even
20500 starting Gnus first if necessary.
20502 when posting and checking whether a group exists or not, just
20503 ask the nntp server instead of relying on the active hashtb.
20505 buttonize the output of `C-c C-a' in an apropos-like way.
20507 `G p' should understand process/prefix, and allow editing
20508 of several groups at once.
20510 command to create an ephemeral nnvirtual group that
20511 matches some regexp(s).
20513 nndoc should understand "Content-Type: message/rfc822" forwarded messages.
20515 it should be possible to score "thread" on the From header.
20517 hitting RET on a "gnus-uu-archive" pseudo article should unpack it.
20519 `B i' should display the article at once in the summary buffer.
20521 remove the "*" mark at once when unticking an article.
20523 `M-s' should highlight the matching text.
20525 when checking for duplicated mails, use Resent-Message-ID if present.
20527 killing and yanking groups in topics should be better. If killing one copy
20528 of a group that exists in multiple topics, only that copy should
20529 be removed. Yanking should insert the copy, and yanking topics
20530 should be possible to be interspersed with the other yankings.
20532 command for enter a group just to read the cached articles. A way to say
20533 "ignore the nntp connection; just read from the cache."
20535 `X u' should decode base64 articles.
20537 a way to hide all "inner" cited text, leaving just the most
20538 recently cited text.
20540 nnvirtual should be asynchronous.
20542 after editing an article, gnus-original-article-buffer should
20545 there should probably be a way to make Gnus not connect to the
20546 server and just read the articles in the server
20548 allow a `set-default' (or something) to change the default
20549 value of nnoo variables.
20551 a command to import group infos from a .newsrc.eld file.
20553 groups from secondary servers have the entire select method
20554 listed in each group info.
20556 a command for just switching from the summary buffer to the group
20559 a way to specify that some incoming mail washing functions
20560 should only be applied to some groups.
20562 Message `C-f C-t' should ask the user whether to heed
20563 mail-copies-to: never.
20565 new group parameter -- `post-to-server' that says to post
20566 using the current server. Also a variable to do the same.
20568 the slave dribble files should auto-save to the slave file names.
20570 a group parameter that says what articles to display on group entry, based
20573 a way to visually distinguish slave Gnusae from masters. (Whip instead
20576 Use DJ Bernstein "From " quoting/dequoting, where applicable.
20578 Why is hide-citation-maybe and hide-citation different? Also
20581 group user-defined meta-parameters.
20585 From: John Griffith <griffith@@sfs.nphil.uni-tuebingen.de>
20587 I like the option for trying to retrieve the FAQ for a group and I was
20588 thinking it would be great if for those newsgroups that had archives
20589 you could also try to read the archive for that group. Part of the
20590 problem is that archives are spread all over the net, unlike FAQs.
20591 What would be best I suppose is to find the one closest to your site.
20593 In any case, there is a list of general news group archives at @*
20594 ftp://ftp.neosoft.com/pub/users/claird/news.lists/newsgroup_archives.html
20601 From: Jason L Tibbitts III <tibbs@@hpc.uh.edu>
20602 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
20604 (gnus-group-add-parameter group
20605 (cons 'gnus-group-date-last-entered (list (current-time-string))))))
20607 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
20608 "Return the date the group was last read."
20609 (cond ((car (gnus-group-get-parameter gnus-tmp-group 'gnus-group-date-last-entered)))
20614 tanken var at når du bruker `gnus-startup-file' som prefix (FOO) til å lete
20615 opp en fil FOO-SERVER, FOO-SERVER.el, FOO-SERVER.eld, kan du la den være en
20616 liste hvor du bruker hvert element i listen som FOO, istedet. da kunne man
20617 hatt forskjellige serveres startup-filer forskjellige steder.
20621 LMI> Well, nnbabyl could alter the group info to heed labels like
20622 LMI> answered and read, I guess.
20624 It could also keep them updated (the same for the Status: header of
20627 They could be used like this:
20631 `M l <name> RET' add label <name> to current message.
20632 `M u <name> RET' remove label <name> from current message.
20633 `/ l <expr> RET' limit summary buffer according to <expr>.
20635 <expr> would be a boolean expression on the labels, e.g.
20637 `/ l bug & !fixed RET'
20640 would show all the messages which are labeled `bug' but not labeled
20643 One could also imagine the labels being used for highlighting, or
20644 affect the summary line format.
20648 Sender: abraham@@dina.kvl.dk
20650 I'd like a gnus-find-file which work like find file, except that it
20651 would recognize things that looks like messages or folders:
20653 - If it is a directory containing numbered files, create an nndir
20656 - For other directories, create a nneething summary buffer.
20658 - For files matching "\\`From ", create a nndoc/mbox summary.
20660 - For files matching "\\`BABYL OPTIONS:", create a nndoc/baby summary.
20662 - For files matching "\\`[^ \t\n]+:", create an *Article* buffer.
20664 - For other files, just find them normally.
20666 I'd like `nneething' to use this function, so it would work on a
20667 directory potentially containing mboxes or babyl files.
20670 Please send a mail to bwarsaw@@cnri.reston.va.us (Barry A. Warsaw) and
20671 tell him what you are doing.
20674 Currently, I get prompted:
20678 decend into sci.something ?
20682 The problem above is that since there is really only one subsection of
20683 science, shouldn't it prompt you for only descending sci.something? If
20684 there was a sci.somethingelse group or section, then it should prompt
20685 for sci? first the sci.something? then sci.somethingelse?...
20688 Ja, det burde være en måte å si slikt. Kanskje en ny variabel?
20689 `gnus-use-few-score-files'? SÃ¥ kunne score-regler legges til den
20690 "mest" lokale score-fila. F. eks. ville no-gruppene betjenes av
20691 "no.all.SCORE", osv.
20694 What i want is for Gnus to treat any sequence or combination of the following
20695 as a single spoiler warning and hide it all, replacing it with a "Next Page"
20701 more than n blank lines
20703 more than m identical lines
20704 (which should be replaced with button to show them)
20706 any whitespace surrounding any of the above
20710 Well, we could allow a new value to `gnus-thread-ignore-subject' --
20711 `spaces', or something. (We could even default to that.) And then
20712 subjects that differ in white space only could be considered the
20713 "same" subject for threading purposes.
20716 Modes to preprocess the contents (e.g. jka-compr) use the second form
20717 "(REGEXP FUNCTION NON-NIL)" while ordinary modes (e.g. tex) use the first
20718 form "(REGEXP . FUNCTION)", so you could use it to distinguish between
20719 those two types of modes. (auto-modes-alist, insert-file-contents-literally.)
20722 Under XEmacs -- do funny article marks:
20725 soup - bowl of soup
20726 score below - dim light bulb
20727 score over - bright light bulb
20730 Yes. I think the algorithm is as follows:
20735 show-list-of-articles-in-group
20736 if (key-pressed == SPACE)
20737 if (no-more-articles-in-group-to-select)
20738 if (articles-selected)
20739 start-reading-selected-articles;
20740 junk-unread-articles;
20745 else if (key-pressed = '.')
20746 if (consolidated-menus) # same as hide-thread in Gnus
20747 select-thread-under-cursor;
20749 select-article-under-cursor;
20753 if (key-pressed == SPACE)
20754 if (more-pages-in-article)
20756 else if (more-selected-articles-to-read)
20763 My precise need here would have been to limit files to Incoming*.
20764 One could think of some `nneething-only-files' variable, but I guess
20765 it would have been unacceptable if one was using many unrelated such
20768 A more useful approach would be to, in response to the `G D' prompt, be
20769 allowed to say something like: `~/.mail/Incoming*', somewhat limiting
20770 the top-level directory only (in case directories would be matched by
20771 the wildcard expression).
20774 It would be nice if it also handled
20776 <URL:news://sunsite.auc.dk/>
20778 which should correspond to `B nntp RET sunsite.auc.dk' in *Group*.
20783 Take a look at w3-menu.el in the Emacs-W3 distribution - this works out
20784 really well. Each menu is 'named' by a symbol that would be on a
20785 gnus-*-menus (where * would be whatever, but at least group, summary, and
20786 article versions) variable.
20788 So for gnus-summary-menus, I would set to '(sort mark dispose ...)
20790 A value of '1' would just put _all_ the menus in a single 'GNUS' menu in
20791 the main menubar. This approach works really well for Emacs-W3 and VM.
20795 nndoc should take care to create unique Message-IDs for all its
20798 gnus-score-followup-article only works when you have a summary buffer
20799 active. Make it work when posting from the group buffer as well.
20800 (message-sent-hook).
20802 rewrite gnus-demon to use run-with-idle-timers.
20805 * Enhancements to Gnus:
20809 * gnus-servers (gnus-start-server-buffer?)--enters Gnus and goes
20810 straight to the server buffer, without opening any connections to
20813 * gnus-server-read-server-newsrc--produces a buffer very similar to
20814 the group buffer, but with only groups from that server listed;
20815 quitting this buffer returns to the server buffer.
20818 add a command to check the integrity of an nnfolder folder --
20819 go through the article numbers and see that there are no duplicates,
20823 `unsmileyfy-buffer' to undo smileification.
20826 a command to give all relevant info on an article, including all
20830 when doing `-request-accept-article', the backends should do
20831 the nnmail duplicate checking.
20834 allow `message-signature-file' to be a function to return the
20835 value of the signature file.
20838 In addition, I would love it if I could configure message-tab so that it
20839 could call `bbdb-complete-name' in other headers. So, some sort of
20842 (setq message-tab-alist
20843 '((message-header-regexp message-expand-group)
20844 ("^\\(To\\|[cC]c\\|[bB]cc\\)" bbdb-complete-name)))
20846 then you could run the relevant function to complete the information in
20850 cache the newsgroups file locally to avoid reloading it all the time.
20853 a command to import a buffer into a group.
20856 nnweb should allow fetching by Message-ID from servers.
20859 point in the article buffer doesn't always go to the
20860 beginning of the buffer when selecting new articles.
20863 a command to process mark all unread articles.
20866 `gnus-gather-threads-by-references-and-subject' -- first
20867 do gathering by references, and then go through the dummy roots and
20868 do more gathering by subject.
20871 gnus-uu-mark-in-numerical-order -- process mark articles in
20872 article numerical order.
20875 (gnus-thread-total-score
20876 (gnus-id-to-thread (mail-header-id (gnus-summary-article-header))))
20880 sorting by score is wrong when using sparse threads.
20883 a command to fetch an arbitrary article -- without having to be
20884 in the summary buffer.
20887 a new nncvs backend. Each group would show an article, using
20888 version branches as threading, checkin date as the date, etc.
20891 http://www.dejanews.com/forms/dnsetfilter_exp.html ?
20892 This filter allows one to construct advance queries on the Dejanews
20893 database such as specifying start and end dates, subject, author,
20894 and/or newsgroup name.
20897 new Date header scoring type -- older, newer
20900 use the summary toolbar in the article buffer.
20903 a command to fetch all articles that are less than X days old.
20906 in pick mode, `q' should save the list of selected articles in the
20907 group info. The next time the group is selected, these articles
20908 will automatically get the process mark.
20911 Isn't it possible to (also?) allow M-^ to automatically try the
20912 default server if it fails on the current server? (controlled by a
20913 user variable, (nil, t, 'ask)).
20916 make it possible to cancel articles using the select method for the
20920 `gnus-summary-select-article-on-entry' or something. It'll default
20921 to t and will select whatever article decided by `gnus-auto-select-first'.
20924 a new variable to control which selection commands should be unselecting.
20925 `first', `best', `next', `prev', `next-unread', `prev-unread' are
20929 be able to select groups that have no articles in them
20930 to be able to post in them (using the current select method).
20933 be able to post via DejaNews.
20936 `x' should retain any sortings that have been performed.
20939 allow the user to specify the precedence of the secondary marks. Also
20940 allow them to be displayed separately.
20943 gnus-summary-save-in-pipe should concatenate the results from
20944 the processes when doing a process marked pipe.
20947 a new match type, like Followup, but which adds Thread matches on all
20948 articles that match a certain From header.
20951 a function that can be read from kill-emacs-query-functions to offer
20952 saving living summary buffers.
20955 a function for selecting a particular group which will contain
20956 the articles listed in a list of article numbers/id's.
20959 a battery of character translation functions to translate common
20960 Mac, MS (etc) characters into ISO 8859-1.
20963 (defun article-fix-m$word ()
20964 "Fix M$Word smartquotes in an article."
20967 (let ((buffer-read-only nil))
20968 (goto-char (point-min))
20969 (while (search-forward "\221" nil t)
20970 (replace-match "`" t t))
20971 (goto-char (point-min))
20972 (while (search-forward "\222" nil t)
20973 (replace-match "'" t t))
20974 (goto-char (point-min))
20975 (while (search-forward "\223" nil t)
20976 (replace-match "\"" t t))
20977 (goto-char (point-min))
20978 (while (search-forward "\224" nil t)
20979 (replace-match "\"" t t)))))
20984 (add-hook 'gnus-exit-query-functions
20986 (if (and (file-exists-p nnmail-spool-file)
20987 (> (nnheader-file-size nnmail-spool-file) 0))
20988 (yes-or-no-p "New mail has arrived. Quit Gnus anyways? ")
20989 (y-or-n-p "Are you sure you want to quit Gnus? "))))
20993 allow message-default-headers to be a function.
20996 new Date score match types -- < > = (etc) that take floating point
20997 numbers and match on the age of the article.
21001 > > > If so, I've got one gripe: It seems that when I fire up gnus 5.2.25
21002 > > > under xemacs-19.14, it's creating a new frame, but is erasing the
21003 > > > buffer in the frame that it was called from =:-O
21005 > > Hm. How do you start up Gnus? From the toolbar or with
21006 > > `M-x gnus-other-frame'?
21008 > I normally start it up from the toolbar; at
21009 > least that's the way I've caught it doing the
21014 all commands that react to the process mark should push
21015 the current process mark set onto the stack.
21018 gnus-article-hide-pgp
21019 Selv ville jeg nok ha valgt å slette den dersom teksten matcher
21021 "\\(This\s+\\)?[^ ]+ has been automatically signed by"
21023 og det er maks hundre tegn mellom match-end og ----linja. Men -det-
21024 er min type heuristikk og langt fra alles.
21027 `gnus-subscribe-sorted' -- insert new groups where they would have been
21028 sorted to if `gnus-group-sort-function' were run.
21031 gnus-(group,summary)-highlight should respect any `face' text props set
21035 use run-with-idle-timer for gnus-demon instead of the
21036 home-brewed stuff for better reliability.
21039 add a way to select which NoCeM type to apply -- spam, troll, etc.
21042 nndraft-request-group should tally auto-save files.
21045 implement nntp-retry-on-break and nntp-command-timeout.
21048 gnus-article-highlight-limit that says when not to highlight (long)
21052 (nnoo-set SERVER VARIABLE VALUE)
21058 interrupitng agent fetching of articles should save articles.
21061 command to open a digest group, and copy all the articles there to the
21065 a variable to disable article body highlights if there's more than
21066 X characters in the body.
21069 handle 480/381 authinfo requests separately.
21072 include the texi/dir file in the distribution.
21075 format spec to "tab" to a position.
21078 Move all prompting to the new `M-n' default style.
21081 command to display all dormant articles.
21084 gnus-auto-select-next makeover -- list of things it should do.
21087 a score match type that adds scores matching on From if From has replied
21088 to something someone else has said.
21091 Read Netscape discussion groups:
21092 snews://secnews.netscape.com/netscape.communicator.unix
21095 One command to edit the original version if an article, and one to edit
21096 the displayed version.
21099 @kbd{T v} -- make all process-marked articles the children of the
21103 Switch from initial text to the new default text mechanism.
21106 How about making it possible to expire local articles? Will it be
21107 possible to make various constraints on when an article can be
21108 expired, e.g. (read), (age > 14 days), or the more interesting (read
21112 New limit command---limit to articles that have a certain string
21113 in the head or body.
21116 Allow breaking lengthy @sc{nntp} commands.
21119 gnus-article-highlight-limit, to disable highlighting in big articles.
21122 Editing an article should put the article to be edited
21123 in a special, unique buffer.
21126 A command to send a mail to the admin-address group param.
21129 A Date scoring type that will match if the article
21130 is less than a certain number of days old.
21133 New spec: %~(tab 56) to put point on column 56
21136 Allow Gnus Agent scoring to use normal score files.
21139 Rething the Agent active file thing. `M-g' doesn't update the active
21140 file, for instance.
21143 With dummy roots, `^' and then selecing the first article
21144 in any other dummy thread will make Gnus highlight the
21145 dummy root instead of the first article.
21148 Propagate all group properties (marks, article numbers, etc) up to the
21149 topics for displaying.
21152 `n' in the group buffer with topics should go to the next group
21153 with unread articles, even if that group is hidden in a topic.
21156 gnus-posting-styles doesn't work in drafts.
21159 gnus-summary-limit-include-cached is slow when there are
21160 many articles in the cache, since it regenerates big parts of the
21161 summary buffer for each article.
21164 Implement gnus-batch-brew-soup.
21167 Group parameters and summary commands for un/subscribing to mailing
21171 Introduce nnmail-home-directory.
21174 gnus-fetch-group and friends should exit Gnus when the user
21178 The jingle is only played on the second invocation of Gnus.
21181 Bouncing articles should do MIME.
21184 Crossposted articles should "inherit" the % or @ mark from the other
21185 groups it has been crossposted to, or something. (Agent.)
21188 If point is on a group that appears multiple times in topics, and
21189 you press `l', point will move to the first instance of the group.
21192 A spec for the group line format to display the number of
21193 agent-downloaded articles in the group.
21196 Some nntp servers never respond when posting, so there should be a
21197 timeout for all commands.
21200 When stading on a topic line and `t'-ing, point goes to the last line.
21201 It should go somewhere else.
21204 I'm having trouble accessing a newsgroup with a "+" in its name with
21205 Gnus. There is a new newsgroup on msnews.microsoft.com named
21206 "microsoft.public.multimedia.directx.html+time" that I'm trying to
21208 "nntp+msnews.microsoft.com:microsoft.public.multimedia.directx.html+time"
21209 but it gives an error that it cant access the group.
21211 Is the "+" character illegal in newsgroup names? Is there any way in
21212 Gnus to work around this? (gnus 5.6.45 - XEmacs 20.4)
21219 Subject: Answer to your mails 01.01.1999-01.05.1999
21220 --text follows this line--
21221 Sorry I killfiled you...
21223 Under the subject "foo", you wrote on 01.01.1999:
21225 Under the subject "foo1", you wrote on 01.01.1999:
21230 Allow "orphan" scores in the Agent scoring.
21234 - Edit article's summary line.
21236 - Sort lines in buffer by subject
21238 --> the old subject line appears in Summary buffer, not the one that was
21244 Remove list identifiers from the subject in the summary when doing `^'
21248 Have the Agent write out articles, one by one, as it retrieves them,
21249 to avoid having to re-fetch them all if Emacs should crash while
21253 Be able to forward groups of messages as MIME digests.
21256 nnweb should include the "get whole article" article when getting articles.
21259 When I type W W c (gnus-article-hide-citation) in the summary
21260 buffer, the citations are revealed, but the [+] buttons don't turn
21261 into [-] buttons. (If I click on one of the [+] buttons, it does
21262 turn into a [-] button.)
21265 Perhaps there should be a command to "attach" a buffer of comments to
21266 a message? That is, `B WHATEVER', you're popped into a buffer, write
21267 something, end with `C-c C-c', and then the thing you've written gets
21268 to be the child of the message you're commenting.
21271 Handle external-body parts.
21274 When renaming a group name, nnmail-split-history does not get the group
21278 Allow mail splitting on bodies when using advanced mail splitting.
21281 (body "whatever.text")
21285 Be able to run `J u' from summary buffers.
21288 Solve the halting problem.
21297 @section The Manual
21301 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
21302 either @code{texi2dvi}
21304 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
21305 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
21307 to get what you hold in your hands now.
21309 The following conventions have been used:
21314 This is a @samp{string}
21317 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
21320 This is a @file{file}
21323 This is a @code{symbol}
21327 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
21331 (setq flargnoze "yes")
21334 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
21337 (setq flumphel 'yes)
21340 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
21341 ever get them confused.
21345 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
21346 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
21347 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
21348 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
21349 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
21350 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
21351 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
21357 @node On Writing Manuals
21358 @section On Writing Manuals
21360 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
21361 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
21362 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
21363 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
21364 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
21365 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
21368 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
21369 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
21370 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
21373 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
21374 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
21379 @section Terminology
21381 @cindex terminology
21386 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
21387 News is generally fetched from a nearby @sc{nntp} server, and is
21388 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
21389 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
21390 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
21394 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
21395 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
21396 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
21397 not posting, and replying is not following up.
21401 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
21405 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
21410 Gnus gets fed articles from a number of backends, both news and mail
21411 backends. Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this
21412 is all done by the backends.
21416 Gnus will always use one method (and backend) as the @dfn{native}, or
21417 default, way of getting news.
21421 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
21422 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary backends for getting
21427 Secondary backends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
21428 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
21432 A message that has been posted as news.
21435 @cindex mail message
21436 A message that has been mailed.
21440 A mail message or news article
21444 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
21449 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
21454 A line from the head of an article.
21458 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
21459 collection of @sc{nov} lines.
21463 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the backend for the headers of all
21464 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
21465 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
21466 normal @sc{head} format.
21470 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
21471 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
21472 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
21473 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
21474 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
21475 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
21477 @item killed groups
21478 @cindex killed groups
21479 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
21480 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
21482 @item zombie groups
21483 @cindex zombie groups
21484 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
21487 @cindex active file
21488 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
21489 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
21490 is rather large, as you might surmise.
21493 @cindex bogus groups
21494 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
21495 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
21496 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
21499 @cindex activating groups
21500 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
21501 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
21502 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
21506 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
21508 @item select method
21509 @cindex select method
21510 A structure that specifies the backend, the server and the virtual
21513 @item virtual server
21514 @cindex virtual server
21515 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
21516 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
21517 whole is a virtual server.
21521 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
21522 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
21525 @item ephemeral groups
21526 @cindex ephemeral groups
21527 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
21528 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
21529 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
21532 @cindex solid groups
21533 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
21534 group buffer are solid groups.
21536 @item sparse articles
21537 @cindex sparse articles
21538 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
21539 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
21543 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
21544 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
21548 @cindex thread root
21549 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
21550 articles in the thread.
21554 An article that has responses.
21558 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
21562 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
21563 specified by RFC 1153.
21569 @node Customization
21570 @section Customization
21571 @cindex general customization
21573 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
21574 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
21575 for some quite common situations.
21578 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
21579 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
21580 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
21581 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
21585 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
21586 @subsection Slow/Expensive @sc{nntp} Connection
21588 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
21589 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
21590 Gnus has to get from the @sc{nntp} server.
21594 @item gnus-read-active-file
21595 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
21596 entire active file from the server. This file is often v. large. You
21597 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
21598 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
21599 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
21601 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
21602 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
21603 the @sc{nntp} server will not be very fast. Not all @sc{nntp} servers
21604 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
21608 @node Slow Terminal Connection
21609 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
21611 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
21612 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
21613 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
21617 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
21618 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
21619 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
21620 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
21621 horizontal and vertical recentering.
21623 @item gnus-visible-headers
21624 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
21625 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
21626 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
21627 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
21629 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
21631 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
21632 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
21633 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
21636 @item gnus-use-full-window
21637 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
21638 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
21639 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
21640 want to read them anyway.
21642 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
21643 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
21646 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
21647 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
21648 lines, which might save some time.
21652 @node Little Disk Space
21653 @subsection Little Disk Space
21656 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
21657 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
21661 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
21662 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
21663 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
21664 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21667 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
21668 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
21669 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
21670 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21673 @item gnus-save-killed-list
21674 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
21675 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
21676 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
21677 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
21683 @subsection Slow Machine
21684 @cindex slow machine
21686 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
21687 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
21689 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
21690 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
21692 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
21693 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
21694 summary buffer faster.
21698 @node Troubleshooting
21699 @section Troubleshooting
21700 @cindex troubleshooting
21702 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
21710 Make sure your computer is switched on.
21713 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
21714 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
21718 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
21719 like @samp{Gnus v5.46; nntp 4.0} you have the right files loaded. If,
21720 on the other hand, you get something like @samp{NNTP 3.x} or @samp{nntp
21721 flee}, you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
21724 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a FAQ and a
21728 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
21729 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
21730 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
21731 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
21732 something like that.
21735 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
21738 @cindex reporting bugs
21740 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
21742 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
21743 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
21744 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
21745 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
21747 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
21748 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
21749 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
21750 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
21753 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
21754 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
21755 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
21756 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
21757 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
21758 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
21760 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
21761 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
21762 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
21765 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
21766 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful.
21768 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
21769 @cindex ding mailing list
21770 You can also ask on the ding mailing list---@samp{ding@@gnus.org}.
21771 Write to @samp{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
21775 @node Gnus Reference Guide
21776 @section Gnus Reference Guide
21778 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
21779 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
21780 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
21781 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
21784 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
21785 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
21786 backends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
21787 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
21788 and general methods of operation.
21791 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
21792 * Backend Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
21793 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
21794 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
21795 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
21796 * Group Info:: The group info format.
21797 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
21798 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
21799 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
21803 @node Gnus Utility Functions
21804 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
21805 @cindex Gnus utility functions
21806 @cindex utility functions
21808 @cindex internal variables
21810 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
21811 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
21812 Below is a list of the most common ones.
21816 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
21817 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
21818 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
21820 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
21821 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
21822 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
21824 @item gnus-group-real-name
21825 @findex gnus-group-real-name
21826 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
21829 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
21830 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
21831 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
21832 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
21834 @item gnus-get-info
21835 @findex gnus-get-info
21836 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
21838 @item gnus-group-unread
21839 @findex gnus-group-unread
21840 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
21844 @findex gnus-active
21845 The active entry for @var{group}.
21847 @item gnus-set-active
21848 @findex gnus-set-active
21849 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
21851 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
21852 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
21853 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
21856 @item gnus-continuum-version
21857 @findex gnus-continuum-version
21858 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
21859 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
21862 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
21863 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
21864 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
21866 @item gnus-news-group-p
21867 @findex gnus-news-group-p
21868 Says whether @var{group} came from a news backend.
21870 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
21871 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
21872 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
21874 @item gnus-server-to-method
21875 @findex gnus-server-to-method
21876 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
21878 @item gnus-server-equal
21879 @findex gnus-server-equal
21880 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
21882 @item gnus-group-native-p
21883 @findex gnus-group-native-p
21884 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
21886 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
21887 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
21888 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
21890 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
21891 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
21892 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
21894 @item group-group-find-parameter
21895 @findex group-group-find-parameter
21896 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
21897 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
21899 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
21900 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
21901 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
21903 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
21904 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
21905 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
21907 @item gnus-check-backend-function
21908 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
21909 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the backend
21910 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
21913 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
21917 @item gnus-read-method
21918 @findex gnus-read-method
21919 Prompts the user for a select method.
21924 @node Backend Interface
21925 @subsection Backend Interface
21927 Gnus doesn't know anything about @sc{nntp}, spools, mail or virtual
21928 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
21929 server is a @dfn{backend} and some @dfn{backend variables}. As examples
21930 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
21931 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
21932 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
21934 When Gnus asks for information from a backend---say @code{nntp}---on
21935 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
21936 function parameters. (If not, the backend should use the ``current''
21937 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
21938 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
21939 been opened, the function should fail.
21941 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
21942 name. Take this example:
21946 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
21947 (nntp-port-number 4324))
21950 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
21951 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
21953 The backends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
21954 The standard backends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
21955 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
21957 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
21958 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
21959 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
21961 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
21962 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
21963 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
21964 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
21965 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
21966 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
21969 Some backends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} backends, and
21970 some might be said not to be. The latter are backends that generally
21971 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
21972 -- they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
21975 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary backend
21978 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
21981 * Required Backend Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
21982 * Optional Backend Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
21983 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
21984 * Writing New Backends:: Extending old backends.
21985 * Hooking New Backends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
21986 * Mail-like Backends:: Some tips on mail backends.
21990 @node Required Backend Functions
21991 @subsubsection Required Backend Functions
21995 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
21997 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
21998 @code{Message-ID}s. Current backends do not fully support either---only
21999 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most backends do not support
22000 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
22002 The result data should either be HEADs or NOV lines, and the result
22003 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
22004 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
22005 of HEADs and NOV lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
22007 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching "extra
22008 headers", in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
22009 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
22010 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
22011 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the backend finds it
22012 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
22013 number, do maximum fetches.
22015 Here's an example HEAD:
22018 221 1056 Article retrieved.
22019 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
22020 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
22021 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
22022 Subject: Re: Something very droll
22023 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
22024 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
22026 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
22027 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
22028 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
22032 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
22033 these in the data buffer.
22035 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
22039 head = error / valid-head
22040 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
22041 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
22042 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
22043 header = <text> eol
22046 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
22047 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
22051 nov-buffer = *nov-line
22052 nov-line = 8*9 [ field <TAB> ] eol
22053 field = <text except TAB>
22056 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
22060 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
22062 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
22063 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
22065 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The backend
22066 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
22067 server. In fact, it should do so.
22069 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
22070 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
22073 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
22075 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
22076 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
22079 There should be no data returned.
22082 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
22084 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the backend
22085 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that backend
22086 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
22087 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
22089 There should be no data returned.
22092 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
22094 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
22095 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
22096 non-@code{nil} vlue. This function should under no circumstances
22097 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
22099 There should be no data returned.
22102 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
22104 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
22106 There should be no data returned.
22109 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
22111 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
22112 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
22113 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
22114 it would be nice if that were possible.
22116 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
22117 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
22118 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
22119 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
22120 into its article buffer.
22122 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
22123 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
22124 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
22125 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
22126 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
22127 on successful article retrieval.
22130 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
22132 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
22133 making @var{group} the current group.
22135 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
22138 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
22141 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
22144 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
22145 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
22146 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
22147 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
22148 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
22149 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
22150 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
22151 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader.
22154 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
22155 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
22156 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
22160 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
22162 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
22163 a no-op on most backends.
22165 There should be no data returned.
22168 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
22170 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
22173 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
22176 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
22177 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
22180 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
22181 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag.
22184 active-file = *active-line
22185 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
22187 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
22190 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
22191 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
22192 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
22195 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
22197 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
22198 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
22199 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
22200 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
22201 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
22202 clear if the posting could not be completed.
22204 There should be no result data from this function.
22209 @node Optional Backend Functions
22210 @subsubsection Optional Backend Functions
22214 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
22216 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
22217 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
22218 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
22220 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
22221 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
22222 former is in the same format as the data from
22223 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
22224 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
22227 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
22231 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
22233 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the backend for
22234 alterations. This comes in handy if the backend really carries all the
22235 information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
22236 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
22237 should return the (altered) group info.
22239 There should be no result data from this function.
22242 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
22244 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
22245 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
22246 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
22247 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
22248 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
22249 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
22250 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
22251 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
22253 There should be no result data from this function.
22256 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
22258 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
22259 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
22260 @code{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some backends (such as @sc{imap}) however carry
22261 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
22262 propagate the mark information to the server.
22264 ACTION is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
22267 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
22270 Range is a range of articles you wish to update marks on. Action is
22271 @code{set}, @code{add} or @code{del}, respectively used for removing all
22272 existing marks and setting them as specified, adding (preserving the
22273 marks not mentioned) mark and removing (preserving the marks not
22274 mentioned) marks. Mark is a list of marks; where each mark is a symbol.
22275 Currently used marks are @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply},
22276 @code{expire}, @code{killed}, @code{dormant}, @code{save},
22277 @code{download} and @code{unsend}, but your backend should, if possible,
22278 not limit itself to these.
22280 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
22281 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
22282 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
22283 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
22285 An example action list:
22288 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
22289 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
22290 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
22293 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
22294 mark on (currently not used for anything).
22296 There should be no result data from this function.
22298 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
22300 If the user tries to set a mark that the backend doesn't like, this
22301 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
22302 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
22303 @var{mark}. If the backend doesn't care, it must return the original
22304 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
22306 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
22307 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
22308 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
22311 There should be no result data from this function.
22314 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
22316 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
22317 request that the backend check for incoming articles, in one way or
22318 another. A mail backend will typically read the spool file or query the
22319 POP server when this function is invoked. The @var{group} doesn't have
22320 to be heeded---if the backend decides that it is too much work just
22321 scanning for a single group, it may do a total scan of all groups. It
22322 would be nice, however, to keep things local if that's practical.
22324 There should be no result data from this function.
22327 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
22329 The result data from this function should be a description of
22333 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
22335 description = <text>
22338 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
22340 The result data from this function should be the description of all
22341 groups available on the server.
22344 description-buffer = *description-line
22348 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
22350 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
22351 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date
22352 format. The data should be in the active buffer format.
22355 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
22357 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
22359 There should be no return data.
22362 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
22364 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
22365 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
22366 numbers.) It is left up to the backend to decide how old articles
22367 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
22368 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
22371 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
22374 There should be no result data returned.
22377 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM
22380 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
22381 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
22383 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
22384 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
22385 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
22386 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
22387 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
22388 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
22390 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
22391 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
22394 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
22395 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
22397 There should be no data returned.
22400 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
22402 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
22403 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
22404 this function in short order.
22406 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
22407 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
22409 There should be no data returned.
22412 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
22414 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
22415 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
22417 There should be no data returned.
22420 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
22422 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
22423 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
22424 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
22426 There should be no data returned.
22429 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
22431 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
22432 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
22434 There should be no data returned.
22439 @node Error Messaging
22440 @subsubsection Error Messaging
22442 @findex nnheader-report
22443 @findex nnheader-get-report
22444 The backends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
22445 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
22446 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the backend
22447 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
22448 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
22449 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
22452 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
22454 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
22457 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
22458 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
22459 recently reported message for the backend in question. This function
22460 takes one argument---the server symbol.
22462 Internally, these functions access @var{backend}@code{-status-string},
22463 so the @code{nnchoke} backend will have its error message stored in
22464 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
22467 @node Writing New Backends
22468 @subsubsection Writing New Backends
22470 Many backends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
22471 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
22472 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
22473 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
22474 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
22477 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
22478 backends when writing new backends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
22479 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
22481 All the backends declare their public variables and functions by using a
22482 package called @code{nnoo}.
22484 To inherit functions from other backends (and allow other backends to
22485 inherit functions from the current backend), you should use the
22491 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
22492 parameters. For instance:
22495 (nnoo-declare nndir
22499 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
22500 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
22503 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
22504 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
22505 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
22507 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
22508 variables in the parent backends to map the variable to when executing
22509 a function in those backends.
22512 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
22513 "Where nndir will look for groups."
22514 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
22517 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
22518 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
22519 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
22521 @item nnoo-define-basics
22522 This macro defines some common functions that almost all backends should
22526 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
22530 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
22531 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
22532 function as being public so that other backends can inherit it.
22534 @item nnoo-map-functions
22535 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current backend to
22536 functions from the parent backends.
22539 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
22540 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
22541 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
22544 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
22545 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
22546 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
22547 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
22550 This macro allows importing functions from backends. It should be the
22551 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
22552 haven't already been defined.
22558 nnmh-request-newgroups)
22562 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
22563 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
22564 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
22569 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} backend.
22572 ;;; nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus
22573 ;; Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22577 (require 'nnheader)
22581 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
22583 (nnoo-declare nndir
22586 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
22587 "Where nndir will look for groups."
22588 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
22590 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
22591 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
22594 (defvoo nndir-current-group "" nil nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
22595 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
22596 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
22598 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
22599 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
22601 ;;; Interface functions.
22603 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
22605 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
22606 (setq nndir-directory
22607 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
22609 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
22610 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
22611 (push `(nndir-current-group
22612 ,(file-name-nondirectory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
22614 (push `(nndir-top-directory
22615 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
22617 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
22619 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
22620 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
22621 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
22622 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
22623 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
22627 nnmh-status-message
22629 nnmh-request-newgroups))
22635 @node Hooking New Backends Into Gnus
22636 @subsubsection Hooking New Backends Into Gnus
22638 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
22639 Having Gnus start using your new backend is rather easy---you just
22640 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
22641 enter the backend into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
22643 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the backend name and
22644 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
22649 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
22652 The abilities can be:
22656 This is a mailish backend---followups should (probably) go via mail.
22658 This is a newsish backend---followups should (probably) go via news.
22660 This backend supports both mail and news.
22662 This is neither a post nor mail backend---it's something completely
22665 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
22666 articles and groups.
22668 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
22669 true for almost all backends.
22670 @item prompt-address
22671 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
22672 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for backends like
22673 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
22677 @node Mail-like Backends
22678 @subsubsection Mail-like Backends
22680 One of the things that separate the mail backends from the rest of the
22681 backends is the heavy dependence by the mail backends on common
22682 functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the definition of
22683 @code{nnml-request-scan}:
22686 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
22687 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
22688 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
22691 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
22692 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
22695 This function takes four parameters.
22699 This should be a symbol to designate which backend is responsible for
22702 @item exit-function
22703 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
22705 @item temp-directory
22706 Where the temporary files should be stored.
22709 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
22710 performed for one group only.
22713 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{backend}@code{-save-mail} to
22714 save each article. @var{backend}@code{-active-number} will be called to
22715 find the article number assigned to this article.
22717 The function also uses the following variables:
22718 @var{backend}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
22719 this backend); and @var{backend}@code{-group-alist} and
22720 @var{backend}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
22721 @var{backend}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
22725 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
22726 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
22730 @node Score File Syntax
22731 @subsection Score File Syntax
22733 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
22734 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
22735 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
22737 Here's a typical score file:
22741 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
22748 BNF definition of a score file:
22751 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
22752 element = rule / atom
22753 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
22754 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
22755 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
22756 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
22758 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
22759 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
22760 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
22761 date-header = "date"
22762 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
22763 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
22764 score = "nil" / <integer>
22765 date = "nil" / <natural number>
22766 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
22767 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
22768 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
22769 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
22770 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
22771 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
22772 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
22773 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
22774 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
22775 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
22776 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
22777 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
22778 exclude-files / read-only / touched
22779 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
22780 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
22781 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
22782 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
22783 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
22784 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
22785 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
22786 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
22787 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
22788 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
22789 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
22790 eval = "eval" space <form>
22791 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
22794 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
22797 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
22798 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
22799 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
22800 one looong line, then that's ok.
22802 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
22803 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
22807 @subsection Headers
22809 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
22810 corresponds to the @sc{nov} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
22811 almost suspect that the author looked at the @sc{nov} specification and
22812 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
22814 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
22815 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
22816 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
22817 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
22818 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
22819 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
22820 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
22822 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
22823 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
22824 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
22825 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
22826 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
22828 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
22829 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
22835 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
22836 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
22838 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
22839 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
22840 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
22841 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
22843 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
22847 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
22850 is transformed into
22853 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
22856 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
22857 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
22860 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
22863 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
22864 is slightly tricky:
22867 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
22873 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
22876 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
22882 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
22889 and is equal to the previous range.
22891 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
22892 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
22893 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
22897 range = simple-range / normal-range
22898 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
22899 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
22900 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
22901 number *[ " " contents ]
22904 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
22905 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
22906 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
22907 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
22908 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
22913 @subsection Group Info
22915 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
22916 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
22917 describes the group.
22919 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
22920 second is a more complex one:
22923 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
22925 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
22926 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
22928 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
22931 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
22932 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
22933 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
22934 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
22935 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
22936 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
22937 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
22938 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
22939 this section is about.
22941 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
22942 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
22943 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
22945 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
22948 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
22949 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
22950 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
22951 group = quote <string> quote
22952 ralevel = rank / level
22953 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
22954 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
22955 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
22957 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
22958 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
22959 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
22960 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
22963 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
22964 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
22967 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
22968 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
22971 @item gnus-info-group
22972 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
22973 @findex gnus-info-group
22974 @findex gnus-info-set-group
22975 Get/set the group name.
22977 @item gnus-info-rank
22978 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
22979 @findex gnus-info-rank
22980 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
22981 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
22983 @item gnus-info-level
22984 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
22985 @findex gnus-info-level
22986 @findex gnus-info-set-level
22987 Get/set the group level.
22989 @item gnus-info-score
22990 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
22991 @findex gnus-info-score
22992 @findex gnus-info-set-score
22993 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
22995 @item gnus-info-read
22996 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
22997 @findex gnus-info-read
22998 @findex gnus-info-set-read
22999 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
23001 @item gnus-info-marks
23002 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
23003 @findex gnus-info-marks
23004 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
23005 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
23007 @item gnus-info-method
23008 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
23009 @findex gnus-info-method
23010 @findex gnus-info-set-method
23011 Get/set the group select method.
23013 @item gnus-info-params
23014 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
23015 @findex gnus-info-params
23016 @findex gnus-info-set-params
23017 Get/set the group parameters.
23020 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
23021 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
23023 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
23024 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
23025 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
23026 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
23029 @node Extended Interactive
23030 @subsection Extended Interactive
23031 @cindex interactive
23032 @findex gnus-interactive
23034 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
23035 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
23036 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
23039 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
23040 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
23045 The best thing to do would have been to implement
23046 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
23047 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
23048 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
23049 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
23050 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
23051 @code{interactive}.
23053 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
23058 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
23059 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
23063 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
23064 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
23065 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
23068 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
23072 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
23076 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
23082 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
23083 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
23087 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
23088 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
23089 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
23091 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
23092 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
23093 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
23094 Gnus, that's very useful.
23096 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
23097 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
23098 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
23099 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
23100 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
23101 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
23102 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
23103 following function:
23106 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
23110 (,function ,@@args))
23114 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
23115 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
23116 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
23119 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
23120 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
23121 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
23123 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
23124 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
23125 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
23128 @node Various File Formats
23129 @subsection Various File Formats
23132 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
23133 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
23137 @node Active File Format
23138 @subsubsection Active File Format
23140 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
23141 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
23144 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
23147 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
23148 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
23149 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
23150 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
23151 no.general 1000 900 y
23154 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
23157 active = *group-line
23158 group-line = group space high-number space low-number space flag <NEWLINE>
23159 group = <non-white-space string>
23161 high-number = <non-negative integer>
23162 low-number = <positive integer>
23163 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
23166 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
23167 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
23170 @node Newsgroups File Format
23171 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
23173 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
23174 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
23175 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
23178 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
23179 Here's the definition:
23183 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
23184 group = <non-white-space string>
23186 description = <string>
23191 @node Emacs for Heathens
23192 @section Emacs for Heathens
23194 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
23195 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
23196 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{M-C-a}'', ``kill the
23197 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
23198 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
23199 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
23200 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
23204 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
23205 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
23210 @subsection Keystrokes
23214 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
23217 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
23220 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
23221 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
23222 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
23223 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
23224 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
23225 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
23227 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
23228 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
23229 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
23230 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
23231 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
23232 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
23233 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
23235 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
23236 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{M-C-m}
23237 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
23238 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
23239 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
23240 ``Press @kbd{M-C-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
23241 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
23243 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
23244 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
23245 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
23246 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
23247 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
23253 @subsection Emacs Lisp
23255 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
23256 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
23257 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
23258 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
23260 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
23261 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
23262 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
23263 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
23264 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
23265 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
23266 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
23269 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
23270 write the following:
23273 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
23276 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
23277 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
23278 you can go and fill your @code{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
23281 If you have put that thing in your @code{.emacs} file, it will be read
23282 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
23283 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
23284 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
23285 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
23287 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
23288 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
23289 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
23293 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
23297 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
23300 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
23301 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
23304 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
23307 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
23308 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
23311 @include gnus-faq.texi